1 //===- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes --------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 //  This file implements the ASTContext interface.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
14 #include "CXXABI.h"
15 #include "Interp/Context.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/APValue.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/ASTConcept.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ASTTypeTraits.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/AttrIterator.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Decl.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
29 #include "clang/AST/DeclOpenMP.h"
30 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
31 #include "clang/AST/DeclarationName.h"
32 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h"
33 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
34 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
35 #include "clang/AST/ExprConcepts.h"
36 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
37 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
38 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
39 #include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h"
40 #include "clang/AST/ParentMapContext.h"
41 #include "clang/AST/RawCommentList.h"
42 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
43 #include "clang/AST/Stmt.h"
44 #include "clang/AST/TemplateBase.h"
45 #include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h"
46 #include "clang/AST/Type.h"
47 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
48 #include "clang/AST/UnresolvedSet.h"
49 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
50 #include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h"
51 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
52 #include "clang/Basic/CommentOptions.h"
53 #include "clang/Basic/ExceptionSpecificationType.h"
54 #include "clang/Basic/IdentifierTable.h"
55 #include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
56 #include "clang/Basic/LangOptions.h"
57 #include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h"
58 #include "clang/Basic/Module.h"
59 #include "clang/Basic/NoSanitizeList.h"
60 #include "clang/Basic/ObjCRuntime.h"
61 #include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h"
62 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
63 #include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h"
64 #include "clang/Basic/TargetCXXABI.h"
65 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
66 #include "clang/Basic/XRayLists.h"
67 #include "llvm/ADT/APFixedPoint.h"
68 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
69 #include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h"
70 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
71 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
72 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
73 #include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
74 #include "llvm/ADT/None.h"
75 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
76 #include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
77 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
78 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
79 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
80 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
81 #include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
82 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
83 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
84 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
85 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
86 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
87 #include "llvm/Support/MD5.h"
88 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
89 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
90 #include <algorithm>
91 #include <cassert>
92 #include <cstddef>
93 #include <cstdint>
94 #include <cstdlib>
95 #include <map>
96 #include <memory>
97 #include <string>
98 #include <tuple>
99 #include <utility>
100 
101 using namespace clang;
102 
103 enum FloatingRank {
104   BFloat16Rank, Float16Rank, HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
105 };
106 
107 /// \returns location that is relevant when searching for Doc comments related
108 /// to \p D.
109 static SourceLocation getDeclLocForCommentSearch(const Decl *D,
110                                                  SourceManager &SourceMgr) {
111   assert(D);
112 
113   // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
114   if (D->isImplicit())
115     return {};
116 
117   // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
118   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
119     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
120       return {};
121   }
122 
123   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
124     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
125         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
126       return {};
127   }
128 
129   if (const auto *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
130     if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
131       return {};
132   }
133 
134   if (const auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
135     TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
136     if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
137         TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
138       return {};
139   }
140 
141   if (const auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
142     if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
143       return {};
144   }
145   if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
146     // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
147     // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
148     if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
149       return {};
150   }
151   // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
152   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
153     return {};
154 
155   // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
156   // documentation.
157   if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
158       isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
159       isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
160     return {};
161 
162   // Find declaration location.
163   // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
164   // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
165   // location".
166   // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
167   // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
168   if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
169       isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
170       isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
171       isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D) ||
172       // Allow association with Y across {} in `typedef struct X {} Y`.
173       isa<TypedefDecl>(D))
174     return D->getBeginLoc();
175   else {
176     const SourceLocation DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
177     if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
178       if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
179         // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
180         // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
181         // the "declaration location".
182         return D->getBeginLoc();
183       } else if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
184         // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
185         // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
186         // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl.  In that
187         // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
188         // attach the comment to the tag decl.
189         if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
190             TD->isCompleteDefinition())
191           return SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
192       }
193     }
194     return DeclLoc;
195   }
196 
197   return {};
198 }
199 
200 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(
201     const Decl *D, const SourceLocation RepresentativeLocForDecl,
202     const std::map<unsigned, RawComment *> &CommentsInTheFile) const {
203   // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
204   // can't find the comment.
205   if (RepresentativeLocForDecl.isInvalid() ||
206       !RepresentativeLocForDecl.isFileID())
207     return nullptr;
208 
209   // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
210   if (CommentsInTheFile.empty())
211     return nullptr;
212 
213   // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
214   // file buffer.
215   const std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp =
216       SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(RepresentativeLocForDecl);
217 
218   // Slow path.
219   auto OffsetCommentBehindDecl =
220       CommentsInTheFile.lower_bound(DeclLocDecomp.second);
221 
222   // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
223   if (OffsetCommentBehindDecl != CommentsInTheFile.end()) {
224     RawComment *CommentBehindDecl = OffsetCommentBehindDecl->second;
225     if ((CommentBehindDecl->isDocumentation() ||
226          LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments) &&
227         CommentBehindDecl->isTrailingComment() &&
228         (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
229          isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
230 
231       // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
232       // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
233       if (SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second) ==
234           Comments.getCommentBeginLine(CommentBehindDecl, DeclLocDecomp.first,
235                                        OffsetCommentBehindDecl->first)) {
236         return CommentBehindDecl;
237       }
238     }
239   }
240 
241   // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
242   // Let's look at the previous comment.
243   if (OffsetCommentBehindDecl == CommentsInTheFile.begin())
244     return nullptr;
245 
246   auto OffsetCommentBeforeDecl = --OffsetCommentBehindDecl;
247   RawComment *CommentBeforeDecl = OffsetCommentBeforeDecl->second;
248 
249   // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
250   if (!(CommentBeforeDecl->isDocumentation() ||
251         LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments) ||
252       CommentBeforeDecl->isTrailingComment())
253     return nullptr;
254 
255   // Decompose the end of the comment.
256   const unsigned CommentEndOffset =
257       Comments.getCommentEndOffset(CommentBeforeDecl);
258 
259   // Get the corresponding buffer.
260   bool Invalid = false;
261   const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
262                                                &Invalid).data();
263   if (Invalid)
264     return nullptr;
265 
266   // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
267   StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndOffset,
268                  DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndOffset);
269 
270   // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
271   // comment and declaration.
272   if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
273     return nullptr;
274 
275   return CommentBeforeDecl;
276 }
277 
278 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
279   const SourceLocation DeclLoc = getDeclLocForCommentSearch(D, SourceMgr);
280 
281   // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
282   // can't find the comment.
283   if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
284     return nullptr;
285 
286   if (ExternalSource && !CommentsLoaded) {
287     ExternalSource->ReadComments();
288     CommentsLoaded = true;
289   }
290 
291   if (Comments.empty())
292     return nullptr;
293 
294   const FileID File = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc).first;
295   const auto CommentsInThisFile = Comments.getCommentsInFile(File);
296   if (!CommentsInThisFile || CommentsInThisFile->empty())
297     return nullptr;
298 
299   return getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(D, DeclLoc, *CommentsInThisFile);
300 }
301 
302 void ASTContext::addComment(const RawComment &RC) {
303   assert(LangOpts.RetainCommentsFromSystemHeaders ||
304          !SourceMgr.isInSystemHeader(RC.getSourceRange().getBegin()));
305   Comments.addComment(RC, LangOpts.CommentOpts, BumpAlloc);
306 }
307 
308 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
309 /// refer to the actual template.
310 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
311 static const Decl &adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl &D) {
312   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&D)) {
313     // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
314     if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
315       return *FTD;
316 
317     // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
318     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
319       return D;
320 
321     // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
322     if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
323       return *FTD;
324 
325     // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
326     if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
327             FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
328       return *MemberDecl;
329 
330     return D;
331   }
332   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&D)) {
333     // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
334     // template?
335     if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
336       if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
337         return *MemberDecl;
338 
339     return D;
340   }
341   if (const auto *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(&D)) {
342     // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
343     if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
344       return *CTD;
345 
346     // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
347     // specialization?
348     if (const auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
349       if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
350         return D;
351       llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
352                          ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
353           PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
354       return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl *>()
355                  ? *static_cast<const Decl *>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>())
356                  : *static_cast<const Decl *>(
357                        PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
358     }
359 
360     // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
361     if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
362             CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
363       return *Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
364 
365     return D;
366   }
367   if (const auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(&D)) {
368     // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
369     if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
370       return *MemberDecl;
371 
372     return D;
373   }
374   // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
375   return D;
376 }
377 
378 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
379                                                 const Decl *D,
380                                                 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
381   if (!D) {
382     if (OriginalDecl)
383       OriginalDecl = nullptr;
384     return nullptr;
385   }
386 
387   D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
388 
389   // Any comment directly attached to D?
390   {
391     auto DeclComment = DeclRawComments.find(D);
392     if (DeclComment != DeclRawComments.end()) {
393       if (OriginalDecl)
394         *OriginalDecl = D;
395       return DeclComment->second;
396     }
397   }
398 
399   // Any comment attached to any redeclaration of D?
400   const Decl *CanonicalD = D->getCanonicalDecl();
401   if (!CanonicalD)
402     return nullptr;
403 
404   {
405     auto RedeclComment = RedeclChainComments.find(CanonicalD);
406     if (RedeclComment != RedeclChainComments.end()) {
407       if (OriginalDecl)
408         *OriginalDecl = RedeclComment->second;
409       auto CommentAtRedecl = DeclRawComments.find(RedeclComment->second);
410       assert(CommentAtRedecl != DeclRawComments.end() &&
411              "This decl is supposed to have comment attached.");
412       return CommentAtRedecl->second;
413     }
414   }
415 
416   // Any redeclarations of D that we haven't checked for comments yet?
417   // We can't use DenseMap::iterator directly since it'd get invalid.
418   auto LastCheckedRedecl = [this, CanonicalD]() -> const Decl * {
419     auto LookupRes = CommentlessRedeclChains.find(CanonicalD);
420     if (LookupRes != CommentlessRedeclChains.end())
421       return LookupRes->second;
422     return nullptr;
423   }();
424 
425   for (const auto Redecl : D->redecls()) {
426     assert(Redecl);
427     // Skip all redeclarations that have been checked previously.
428     if (LastCheckedRedecl) {
429       if (LastCheckedRedecl == Redecl) {
430         LastCheckedRedecl = nullptr;
431       }
432       continue;
433     }
434     const RawComment *RedeclComment = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(Redecl);
435     if (RedeclComment) {
436       cacheRawCommentForDecl(*Redecl, *RedeclComment);
437       if (OriginalDecl)
438         *OriginalDecl = Redecl;
439       return RedeclComment;
440     }
441     CommentlessRedeclChains[CanonicalD] = Redecl;
442   }
443 
444   if (OriginalDecl)
445     *OriginalDecl = nullptr;
446   return nullptr;
447 }
448 
449 void ASTContext::cacheRawCommentForDecl(const Decl &OriginalD,
450                                         const RawComment &Comment) const {
451   assert(Comment.isDocumentation() || LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
452   DeclRawComments.try_emplace(&OriginalD, &Comment);
453   const Decl *const CanonicalDecl = OriginalD.getCanonicalDecl();
454   RedeclChainComments.try_emplace(CanonicalDecl, &OriginalD);
455   CommentlessRedeclChains.erase(CanonicalDecl);
456 }
457 
458 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
459                    SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
460   const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
461   if (const auto *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
462     const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
463     if (!ID)
464       return;
465     // Add redeclared method here.
466     for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
467       if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
468             Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
469                                   ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
470         Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
471     }
472   }
473 }
474 
475 void ASTContext::attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Decls,
476                                                  const Preprocessor *PP) {
477   if (Comments.empty() || Decls.empty())
478     return;
479 
480   FileID File;
481   for (Decl *D : Decls) {
482     SourceLocation Loc = D->getLocation();
483     if (Loc.isValid()) {
484       // See if there are any new comments that are not attached to a decl.
485       // The location doesn't have to be precise - we care only about the file.
486       File = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Loc).first;
487       break;
488     }
489   }
490 
491   if (File.isInvalid())
492     return;
493 
494   auto CommentsInThisFile = Comments.getCommentsInFile(File);
495   if (!CommentsInThisFile || CommentsInThisFile->empty() ||
496       CommentsInThisFile->rbegin()->second->isAttached())
497     return;
498 
499   // There is at least one comment not attached to a decl.
500   // Maybe it should be attached to one of Decls?
501   //
502   // Note that this way we pick up not only comments that precede the
503   // declaration, but also comments that *follow* the declaration -- thanks to
504   // the lookahead in the lexer: we've consumed the semicolon and looked
505   // ahead through comments.
506 
507   for (const Decl *D : Decls) {
508     assert(D);
509     if (D->isInvalidDecl())
510       continue;
511 
512     D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
513 
514     const SourceLocation DeclLoc = getDeclLocForCommentSearch(D, SourceMgr);
515 
516     if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
517       continue;
518 
519     if (DeclRawComments.count(D) > 0)
520       continue;
521 
522     if (RawComment *const DocComment =
523             getRawCommentForDeclNoCacheImpl(D, DeclLoc, *CommentsInThisFile)) {
524       cacheRawCommentForDecl(*D, *DocComment);
525       comments::FullComment *FC = DocComment->parse(*this, PP, D);
526       ParsedComments[D->getCanonicalDecl()] = FC;
527     }
528   }
529 }
530 
531 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
532                                                     const Decl *D) const {
533   auto *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
534   ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
535   ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
536   ThisDeclInfo->fill();
537   ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
538   if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
539     ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
540   comments::FullComment *CFC =
541     new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
542                                       ThisDeclInfo);
543   return CFC;
544 }
545 
546 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
547   const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
548   return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
549 }
550 
551 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
552                                               const Decl *D,
553                                               const Preprocessor *PP) const {
554   if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl())
555     return nullptr;
556   D = &adjustDeclToTemplate(*D);
557 
558   const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
559   llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
560       ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
561 
562   if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
563     if (Canonical != D) {
564       comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
565       comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
566       return CFC;
567     }
568     return Pos->second;
569   }
570 
571   const Decl *OriginalDecl = nullptr;
572 
573   const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
574   if (!RC) {
575     if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
576       SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
577       const auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
578       if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
579         if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
580           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
581             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
582       if (OMD)
583         addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
584       getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
585       for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
586         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
587           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
588     }
589     else if (const auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
590       // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
591       // does not have one of its own.
592       QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
593       if (const auto *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
594         if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
595           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
596             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
597     }
598     else if (const auto *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
599       while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
600         IC = IC->getSuperClass();
601         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
602           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
603       }
604     }
605     else if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
606       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
607         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
608           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
609     }
610     else if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
611       if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
612         return nullptr;
613       // Check non-virtual bases.
614       for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
615         if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
616           continue;
617         QualType Ty = I.getType();
618         if (Ty.isNull())
619           continue;
620         if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
621           if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
622             continue;
623 
624           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
625             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
626         }
627       }
628       // Check virtual bases.
629       for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
630         if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
631           continue;
632         QualType Ty = I.getType();
633         if (Ty.isNull())
634           continue;
635         if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
636           if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
637             continue;
638           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
639             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
640         }
641       }
642     }
643     return nullptr;
644   }
645 
646   // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
647   // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl.  This is important
648   // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
649   // different across redeclarations.
650   if (D != OriginalDecl && OriginalDecl)
651     return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
652 
653   comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
654   ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
655   return FC;
656 }
657 
658 void
659 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
660                                                    const ASTContext &C,
661                                                TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
662   ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
663   ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
664   ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
665 
666   TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
667   ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
668   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
669                                           PEnd = Params->end();
670        P != PEnd; ++P) {
671     if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
672       ID.AddInteger(0);
673       ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
674       const TypeConstraint *TC = TTP->getTypeConstraint();
675       ID.AddBoolean(TC != nullptr);
676       if (TC)
677         TC->getImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint()->Profile(ID, C,
678                                                         /*Canonical=*/true);
679       if (TTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
680         ID.AddBoolean(true);
681         ID.AddInteger(TTP->getNumExpansionParameters());
682       } else
683         ID.AddBoolean(false);
684       continue;
685     }
686 
687     if (const auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
688       ID.AddInteger(1);
689       ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
690       ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
691       if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
692         ID.AddBoolean(true);
693         ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
694         for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
695           QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
696           ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
697         }
698       } else
699         ID.AddBoolean(false);
700       continue;
701     }
702 
703     auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
704     ID.AddInteger(2);
705     Profile(ID, C, TTP);
706   }
707   Expr *RequiresClause = Parm->getTemplateParameters()->getRequiresClause();
708   ID.AddBoolean(RequiresClause != nullptr);
709   if (RequiresClause)
710     RequiresClause->Profile(ID, C, /*Canonical=*/true);
711 }
712 
713 static Expr *
714 canonicalizeImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint(const ASTContext &C, Expr *IDC,
715                                           QualType ConstrainedType) {
716   // This is a bit ugly - we need to form a new immediately-declared
717   // constraint that references the new parameter; this would ideally
718   // require semantic analysis (e.g. template<C T> struct S {}; - the
719   // converted arguments of C<T> could be an argument pack if C is
720   // declared as template<typename... T> concept C = ...).
721   // We don't have semantic analysis here so we dig deep into the
722   // ready-made constraint expr and change the thing manually.
723   ConceptSpecializationExpr *CSE;
724   if (const auto *Fold = dyn_cast<CXXFoldExpr>(IDC))
725     CSE = cast<ConceptSpecializationExpr>(Fold->getLHS());
726   else
727     CSE = cast<ConceptSpecializationExpr>(IDC);
728   ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> OldConverted = CSE->getTemplateArguments();
729   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 3> NewConverted;
730   NewConverted.reserve(OldConverted.size());
731   if (OldConverted.front().getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack) {
732     // The case:
733     // template<typename... T> concept C = true;
734     // template<C<int> T> struct S; -> constraint is C<{T, int}>
735     NewConverted.push_back(ConstrainedType);
736     for (auto &Arg : OldConverted.front().pack_elements().drop_front(1))
737       NewConverted.push_back(Arg);
738     TemplateArgument NewPack(NewConverted);
739 
740     NewConverted.clear();
741     NewConverted.push_back(NewPack);
742     assert(OldConverted.size() == 1 &&
743            "Template parameter pack should be the last parameter");
744   } else {
745     assert(OldConverted.front().getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&
746            "Unexpected first argument kind for immediately-declared "
747            "constraint");
748     NewConverted.push_back(ConstrainedType);
749     for (auto &Arg : OldConverted.drop_front(1))
750       NewConverted.push_back(Arg);
751   }
752   Expr *NewIDC = ConceptSpecializationExpr::Create(
753       C, CSE->getNamedConcept(), NewConverted, nullptr,
754       CSE->isInstantiationDependent(), CSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack());
755 
756   if (auto *OrigFold = dyn_cast<CXXFoldExpr>(IDC))
757     NewIDC = new (C) CXXFoldExpr(
758         OrigFold->getType(), /*Callee*/nullptr, SourceLocation(), NewIDC,
759         BinaryOperatorKind::BO_LAnd, SourceLocation(), /*RHS=*/nullptr,
760         SourceLocation(), /*NumExpansions=*/None);
761   return NewIDC;
762 }
763 
764 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
765 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
766                                           TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
767   // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
768   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
769   CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, *this, TTP);
770   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
771   CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
772     = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
773   if (Canonical)
774     return Canonical->getParam();
775 
776   // Build a canonical template parameter list.
777   TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
778   SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
779   CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
780   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
781                                           PEnd = Params->end();
782        P != PEnd; ++P) {
783     if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
784       TemplateTypeParmDecl *NewTTP = TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this,
785           getTranslationUnitDecl(), SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
786           TTP->getDepth(), TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
787           TTP->isParameterPack(), TTP->hasTypeConstraint(),
788           TTP->isExpandedParameterPack() ?
789           llvm::Optional<unsigned>(TTP->getNumExpansionParameters()) : None);
790       if (const auto *TC = TTP->getTypeConstraint()) {
791         QualType ParamAsArgument(NewTTP->getTypeForDecl(), 0);
792         Expr *NewIDC = canonicalizeImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint(
793                 *this, TC->getImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint(),
794                 ParamAsArgument);
795         TemplateArgumentListInfo CanonArgsAsWritten;
796         if (auto *Args = TC->getTemplateArgsAsWritten())
797           for (const auto &ArgLoc : Args->arguments())
798             CanonArgsAsWritten.addArgument(
799                 TemplateArgumentLoc(ArgLoc.getArgument(),
800                                     TemplateArgumentLocInfo()));
801         NewTTP->setTypeConstraint(
802             NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
803             DeclarationNameInfo(TC->getNamedConcept()->getDeclName(),
804                                 SourceLocation()), /*FoundDecl=*/nullptr,
805             // Actually canonicalizing a TemplateArgumentLoc is difficult so we
806             // simply omit the ArgsAsWritten
807             TC->getNamedConcept(), /*ArgsAsWritten=*/nullptr, NewIDC);
808       }
809       CanonParams.push_back(NewTTP);
810     } else if (const auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
811       QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
812       TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
813       NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
814       if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
815         SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
816         SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
817         for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
818           ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
819           ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
820                                 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
821         }
822 
823         Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
824                                                 SourceLocation(),
825                                                 SourceLocation(),
826                                                 NTTP->getDepth(),
827                                                 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
828                                                 T,
829                                                 TInfo,
830                                                 ExpandedTypes,
831                                                 ExpandedTInfos);
832       } else {
833         Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
834                                                 SourceLocation(),
835                                                 SourceLocation(),
836                                                 NTTP->getDepth(),
837                                                 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
838                                                 T,
839                                                 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
840                                                 TInfo);
841       }
842       if (AutoType *AT = T->getContainedAutoType()) {
843         if (AT->isConstrained()) {
844           Param->setPlaceholderTypeConstraint(
845               canonicalizeImmediatelyDeclaredConstraint(
846                   *this, NTTP->getPlaceholderTypeConstraint(), T));
847         }
848       }
849       CanonParams.push_back(Param);
850 
851     } else
852       CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
853                                            cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
854   }
855 
856   Expr *CanonRequiresClause = nullptr;
857   if (Expr *RequiresClause = TTP->getTemplateParameters()->getRequiresClause())
858     CanonRequiresClause = RequiresClause;
859 
860   TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
861     = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
862                                        SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
863                                        TTP->getPosition(),
864                                        TTP->isParameterPack(),
865                                        nullptr,
866                          TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
867                                                        SourceLocation(),
868                                                        CanonParams,
869                                                        SourceLocation(),
870                                                        CanonRequiresClause));
871 
872   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
873   Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
874   assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
875   (void)Canonical;
876 
877   // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
878   Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
879   CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
880   return CanonTTP;
881 }
882 
883 TargetCXXABI::Kind ASTContext::getCXXABIKind() const {
884   auto Kind = getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().getKind();
885   return getLangOpts().CXXABI.getValueOr(Kind);
886 }
887 
888 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
889   if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
890 
891   switch (getCXXABIKind()) {
892   case TargetCXXABI::AppleARM64:
893   case TargetCXXABI::Fuchsia:
894   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
895   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
896   case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
897   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
898   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
899   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
900   case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
901   case TargetCXXABI::XL:
902     return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
903   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
904     return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
905   }
906   llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
907 }
908 
909 interp::Context &ASTContext::getInterpContext() {
910   if (!InterpContext) {
911     InterpContext.reset(new interp::Context(*this));
912   }
913   return *InterpContext.get();
914 }
915 
916 ParentMapContext &ASTContext::getParentMapContext() {
917   if (!ParentMapCtx)
918     ParentMapCtx.reset(new ParentMapContext(*this));
919   return *ParentMapCtx.get();
920 }
921 
922 static const LangASMap *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
923                                            const LangOptions &LOpts) {
924   if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
925     // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
926     // language-specific address space.
927     static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
928         0,  // Default
929         1,  // opencl_global
930         3,  // opencl_local
931         2,  // opencl_constant
932         0,  // opencl_private
933         4,  // opencl_generic
934         5,  // opencl_global_device
935         6,  // opencl_global_host
936         7,  // cuda_device
937         8,  // cuda_constant
938         9,  // cuda_shared
939         1,  // sycl_global
940         5,  // sycl_global_device
941         6,  // sycl_global_host
942         3,  // sycl_local
943         0,  // sycl_private
944         10, // ptr32_sptr
945         11, // ptr32_uptr
946         12  // ptr64
947     };
948     return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
949   } else {
950     return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
951   }
952 }
953 
954 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
955                                           const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
956   switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
957   case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
958     return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
959   case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
960     return true;
961   case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
962     return false;
963   }
964   llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
965 }
966 
967 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
968                        IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
969                        Builtin::Context &builtins)
970     : ConstantArrayTypes(this_()), FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
971       TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
972       DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()), AutoTypes(this_()),
973       SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
974       CanonTemplateTemplateParms(this_()), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
975       NoSanitizeL(new NoSanitizeList(LangOpts.NoSanitizeFiles, SM)),
976       XRayFilter(new XRayFunctionFilter(LangOpts.XRayAlwaysInstrumentFiles,
977                                         LangOpts.XRayNeverInstrumentFiles,
978                                         LangOpts.XRayAttrListFiles, SM)),
979       ProfList(new ProfileList(LangOpts.ProfileListFiles, SM)),
980       PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
981       BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), Comments(SM),
982       CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
983       CompCategories(this_()), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
984   TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
985   TraversalScope = {TUDecl};
986 }
987 
988 ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
989   // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
990   // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
991   ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
992 
993   // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
994   for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
995     (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
996 
997   // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
998   // because they can contain DenseMaps.
999   for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
1000        const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
1001        I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
1002     // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
1003     if (auto *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout *>((I++)->second))
1004       R->Destroy(*this);
1005 
1006   for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
1007        I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
1008     // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
1009     if (auto *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout *>((I++)->second))
1010       R->Destroy(*this);
1011   }
1012 
1013   for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
1014                                                     AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
1015        A != AEnd; ++A)
1016     A->second->~AttrVec();
1017 
1018   for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
1019     Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
1020 }
1021 
1022 void ASTContext::setTraversalScope(const std::vector<Decl *> &TopLevelDecls) {
1023   TraversalScope = TopLevelDecls;
1024   getParentMapContext().clear();
1025 }
1026 
1027 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void *), void *Data) const {
1028   Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
1029 }
1030 
1031 void
1032 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
1033   ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
1034 }
1035 
1036 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
1037   llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
1038   llvm::errs() << "  " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
1039 
1040   unsigned counts[] = {
1041 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
1042 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
1043 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
1044     0 // Extra
1045   };
1046 
1047   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
1048     Type *T = Types[i];
1049     counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
1050   }
1051 
1052   unsigned Idx = 0;
1053   unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
1054 #define TYPE(Name, Parent)                                              \
1055   if (counts[Idx])                                                      \
1056     llvm::errs() << "    " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name               \
1057                  << " types, " << sizeof(Name##Type) << " each "        \
1058                  << "(" << counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type)             \
1059                  << " bytes)\n";                                        \
1060   TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type);                       \
1061   ++Idx;
1062 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
1063 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
1064 
1065   llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
1066 
1067   // Implicit special member functions.
1068   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
1069                << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
1070                << " implicit default constructors created\n";
1071   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
1072                << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
1073                << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
1074   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1075     llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
1076                  << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
1077                  << " implicit move constructors created\n";
1078   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
1079                << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
1080                << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
1081   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1082     llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
1083                  << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
1084                  << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
1085   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
1086                << NumImplicitDestructors
1087                << " implicit destructors created\n";
1088 
1089   if (ExternalSource) {
1090     llvm::errs() << "\n";
1091     ExternalSource->PrintStats();
1092   }
1093 
1094   BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
1095 }
1096 
1097 void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
1098                                            bool NotifyListeners) {
1099   if (NotifyListeners)
1100     if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
1101       Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
1102 
1103   MergedDefModules[cast<NamedDecl>(ND->getCanonicalDecl())].push_back(M);
1104 }
1105 
1106 void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
1107   auto It = MergedDefModules.find(cast<NamedDecl>(ND->getCanonicalDecl()));
1108   if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
1109     return;
1110 
1111   auto &Merged = It->second;
1112   llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
1113   for (Module *&M : Merged)
1114     if (!Found.insert(M).second)
1115       M = nullptr;
1116   Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
1117 }
1118 
1119 ArrayRef<Module *>
1120 ASTContext::getModulesWithMergedDefinition(const NamedDecl *Def) {
1121   auto MergedIt =
1122       MergedDefModules.find(cast<NamedDecl>(Def->getCanonicalDecl()));
1123   if (MergedIt == MergedDefModules.end())
1124     return None;
1125   return MergedIt->second;
1126 }
1127 
1128 void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
1129   if (LazyInitializers.empty())
1130     return;
1131 
1132   auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
1133   assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
1134 
1135   auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
1136   LazyInitializers.clear();
1137 
1138   for (auto ID : LazyInits)
1139     Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
1140 
1141   assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
1142          "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
1143 }
1144 
1145 void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
1146   // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
1147   // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
1148   if (const auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
1149     auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
1150 
1151     // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
1152     if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1153       return;
1154 
1155     // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
1156     auto &Imported = *It->second;
1157     if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
1158       Imported.resolve(*this);
1159       auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
1160       if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
1161         D = OnlyDecl;
1162     }
1163   }
1164 
1165   auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
1166   if (!Inits)
1167     Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
1168   Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
1169 }
1170 
1171 void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) {
1172   auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
1173   if (!Inits)
1174     Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
1175   Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
1176                                  IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
1177 }
1178 
1179 ArrayRef<Decl *> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
1180   auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
1181   if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1182     return None;
1183 
1184   auto *Inits = It->second;
1185   Inits->resolve(*this);
1186   return Inits->Initializers;
1187 }
1188 
1189 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
1190   if (!ExternCContext)
1191     ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
1192 
1193   return ExternCContext;
1194 }
1195 
1196 BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1197 ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
1198                                      const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
1199   auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
1200   BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
1201   TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
1202 
1203   return BuiltinTemplate;
1204 }
1205 
1206 BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1207 ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
1208   if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
1209     MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
1210                                                   getMakeIntegerSeqName());
1211   return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
1212 }
1213 
1214 BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1215 ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
1216   if (!TypePackElementDecl)
1217     TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1218                                                    getTypePackElementName());
1219   return TypePackElementDecl;
1220 }
1221 
1222 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1223                                             RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
1224   SourceLocation Loc;
1225   RecordDecl *NewDecl;
1226   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1227     NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1228                                     Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
1229   else
1230     NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1231                                  &Idents.get(Name));
1232   NewDecl->setImplicit();
1233   NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1234       const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
1235   return NewDecl;
1236 }
1237 
1238 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1239                                               StringRef Name) const {
1240   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1241   TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1242       const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1243       SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1244   NewDecl->setImplicit();
1245   return NewDecl;
1246 }
1247 
1248 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
1249   if (!Int128Decl)
1250     Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
1251   return Int128Decl;
1252 }
1253 
1254 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
1255   if (!UInt128Decl)
1256     UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
1257   return UInt128Decl;
1258 }
1259 
1260 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
1261   auto *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
1262   R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
1263   Types.push_back(Ty);
1264 }
1265 
1266 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1267                                   const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
1268   assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1269          "Incorrect target reinitialization");
1270   assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
1271 
1272   this->Target = &Target;
1273   this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1274 
1275   ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1276   AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
1277   AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
1278 
1279   // C99 6.2.5p19.
1280   InitBuiltinType(VoidTy,              BuiltinType::Void);
1281 
1282   // C99 6.2.5p2.
1283   InitBuiltinType(BoolTy,              BuiltinType::Bool);
1284   // C99 6.2.5p3.
1285   if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
1286     InitBuiltinType(CharTy,            BuiltinType::Char_S);
1287   else
1288     InitBuiltinType(CharTy,            BuiltinType::Char_U);
1289   // C99 6.2.5p4.
1290   InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy,        BuiltinType::SChar);
1291   InitBuiltinType(ShortTy,             BuiltinType::Short);
1292   InitBuiltinType(IntTy,               BuiltinType::Int);
1293   InitBuiltinType(LongTy,              BuiltinType::Long);
1294   InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy,          BuiltinType::LongLong);
1295 
1296   // C99 6.2.5p6.
1297   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy,      BuiltinType::UChar);
1298   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy,     BuiltinType::UShort);
1299   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy,       BuiltinType::UInt);
1300   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy,      BuiltinType::ULong);
1301   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy,  BuiltinType::ULongLong);
1302 
1303   // C99 6.2.5p10.
1304   InitBuiltinType(FloatTy,             BuiltinType::Float);
1305   InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy,            BuiltinType::Double);
1306   InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy,        BuiltinType::LongDouble);
1307 
1308   // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1309   InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty,          BuiltinType::Float128);
1310 
1311   // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661-3
1312   InitBuiltinType(Float16Ty,           BuiltinType::Float16);
1313 
1314   // ISO/IEC JTC1 SC22 WG14 N1169 Extension
1315   InitBuiltinType(ShortAccumTy,            BuiltinType::ShortAccum);
1316   InitBuiltinType(AccumTy,                 BuiltinType::Accum);
1317   InitBuiltinType(LongAccumTy,             BuiltinType::LongAccum);
1318   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortAccumTy,    BuiltinType::UShortAccum);
1319   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedAccumTy,         BuiltinType::UAccum);
1320   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongAccumTy,     BuiltinType::ULongAccum);
1321   InitBuiltinType(ShortFractTy,            BuiltinType::ShortFract);
1322   InitBuiltinType(FractTy,                 BuiltinType::Fract);
1323   InitBuiltinType(LongFractTy,             BuiltinType::LongFract);
1324   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortFractTy,    BuiltinType::UShortFract);
1325   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedFractTy,         BuiltinType::UFract);
1326   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongFractTy,     BuiltinType::ULongFract);
1327   InitBuiltinType(SatShortAccumTy,         BuiltinType::SatShortAccum);
1328   InitBuiltinType(SatAccumTy,              BuiltinType::SatAccum);
1329   InitBuiltinType(SatLongAccumTy,          BuiltinType::SatLongAccum);
1330   InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedShortAccumTy, BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum);
1331   InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedAccumTy,      BuiltinType::SatUAccum);
1332   InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedLongAccumTy,  BuiltinType::SatULongAccum);
1333   InitBuiltinType(SatShortFractTy,         BuiltinType::SatShortFract);
1334   InitBuiltinType(SatFractTy,              BuiltinType::SatFract);
1335   InitBuiltinType(SatLongFractTy,          BuiltinType::SatLongFract);
1336   InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedShortFractTy, BuiltinType::SatUShortFract);
1337   InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedFractTy,      BuiltinType::SatUFract);
1338   InitBuiltinType(SatUnsignedLongFractTy,  BuiltinType::SatULongFract);
1339 
1340   // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1341   InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty,            BuiltinType::Int128);
1342   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty,    BuiltinType::UInt128);
1343 
1344   // C++ 3.9.1p5
1345   if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1346     InitBuiltinType(WCharTy,           BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1347   else  // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1348     InitBuiltinType(WCharTy,           BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1349   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1350     WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1351   else {
1352     // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1353     WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1354   }
1355 
1356   WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1357 
1358   // C++20 (proposed)
1359   InitBuiltinType(Char8Ty,              BuiltinType::Char8);
1360 
1361   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1362     InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty,           BuiltinType::Char16);
1363   else // C99
1364     Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1365 
1366   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1367     InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty,           BuiltinType::Char32);
1368   else // C99
1369     Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1370 
1371   // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1372   // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1373   // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1374   // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1375   // expressions.
1376   InitBuiltinType(DependentTy,         BuiltinType::Dependent);
1377 
1378   // Placeholder type for functions.
1379   InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy,          BuiltinType::Overload);
1380 
1381   // Placeholder type for bound members.
1382   InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy,       BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1383 
1384   // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1385   InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy,      BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1386 
1387   // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1388   InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy,        BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1389 
1390   // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1391   InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy,  BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1392 
1393   // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1394   InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy,  BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1395 
1396   // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1397   if (LangOpts.OpenMP) {
1398     InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1399     InitBuiltinType(OMPArrayShapingTy, BuiltinType::OMPArrayShaping);
1400     InitBuiltinType(OMPIteratorTy, BuiltinType::OMPIterator);
1401   }
1402   if (LangOpts.MatrixTypes)
1403     InitBuiltinType(IncompleteMatrixIdxTy, BuiltinType::IncompleteMatrixIdx);
1404 
1405   // C99 6.2.5p11.
1406   FloatComplexTy      = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1407   DoubleComplexTy     = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1408   LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
1409   Float128ComplexTy   = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
1410 
1411   // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
1412   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1413   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
1414   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
1415 
1416   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1417 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1418     InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1419 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
1420 
1421     InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
1422     InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
1423     InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1424     InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
1425     InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
1426 
1427 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
1428     InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id);
1429 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
1430   }
1431 
1432   if (Target.hasAArch64SVETypes()) {
1433 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
1434     InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1435 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
1436   }
1437 
1438   if (Target.getTriple().isPPC64() &&
1439       Target.hasFeature("paired-vector-memops")) {
1440     if (Target.hasFeature("mma")) {
1441 #define PPC_VECTOR_MMA_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
1442       InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id);
1443 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
1444     }
1445 #define PPC_VECTOR_VSX_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
1446     InitBuiltinType(Id##Ty, BuiltinType::Id);
1447 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
1448   }
1449 
1450   if (Target.hasRISCVVTypes()) {
1451 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId)                                        \
1452   InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
1453 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
1454   }
1455 
1456   // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
1457   ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1458                        SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
1459 
1460   ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
1461 
1462   ObjCSuperType = QualType();
1463 
1464   // void * type
1465   if (LangOpts.OpenCLGenericAddressSpace) {
1466     auto Q = VoidTy.getQualifiers();
1467     Q.setAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic);
1468     VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(
1469         getQualifiedType(VoidTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Q)));
1470   } else {
1471     VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1472   }
1473 
1474   // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1475   InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy,           BuiltinType::NullPtr);
1476 
1477   // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1478   InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
1479 
1480   InitBuiltinType(BFloat16Ty, BuiltinType::BFloat16);
1481 
1482   // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1483   VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
1484 
1485   // MSVC predeclares struct _GUID, and we need it to create MSGuidDecls.
1486   if (LangOpts.MicrosoftExt || LangOpts.Borland) {
1487     MSGuidTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("_GUID");
1488     TUDecl->addDecl(MSGuidTagDecl);
1489   }
1490 }
1491 
1492 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
1493   return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1494 }
1495 
1496 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1497   AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1498   if (!Result) {
1499     void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1500     Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1501   }
1502 
1503   return *Result;
1504 }
1505 
1506 /// Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1507 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1508   llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1509   if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1510     Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1511     DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1512   }
1513 }
1514 
1515 // FIXME: Remove ?
1516 MemberSpecializationInfo *
1517 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
1518   assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1519   return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1520       .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1521 }
1522 
1523 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1524 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1525   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1526       TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1527   if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1528     return {};
1529 
1530   return Pos->second;
1531 }
1532 
1533 void
1534 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
1535                                                 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1536                                           SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
1537   assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1538   assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1539   setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1540                                             Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1541 }
1542 
1543 void
1544 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1545                                             TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1546   assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1547          "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1548   TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
1549 }
1550 
1551 NamedDecl *
1552 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) {
1553   auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1554   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
1555     return nullptr;
1556 
1557   return Pos->second;
1558 }
1559 
1560 void
1561 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1562   assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1563           isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1564           isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1565          "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1566   assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) ||
1567           isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) ||
1568           isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) &&
1569          "instantiation did not produce a using decl");
1570   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1571   InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1572 }
1573 
1574 UsingEnumDecl *
1575 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl(UsingEnumDecl *UUD) {
1576   auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl.find(UUD);
1577   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl.end())
1578     return nullptr;
1579 
1580   return Pos->second;
1581 }
1582 
1583 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl(UsingEnumDecl *Inst,
1584                                                   UsingEnumDecl *Pattern) {
1585   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1586   InstantiatedFromUsingEnumDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1587 }
1588 
1589 UsingShadowDecl *
1590 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1591   llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1592     = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1593   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1594     return nullptr;
1595 
1596   return Pos->second;
1597 }
1598 
1599 void
1600 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1601                                                UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1602   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1603   InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1604 }
1605 
1606 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1607   llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1608     = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1609   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1610     return nullptr;
1611 
1612   return Pos->second;
1613 }
1614 
1615 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1616                                                      FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1617   assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1618   assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1619   assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1620          "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
1621 
1622   InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1623 }
1624 
1625 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1626 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1627   return overridden_methods(Method).begin();
1628 }
1629 
1630 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1631 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1632   return overridden_methods(Method).end();
1633 }
1634 
1635 unsigned
1636 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1637   auto Range = overridden_methods(Method);
1638   return Range.end() - Range.begin();
1639 }
1640 
1641 ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1642 ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1643   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1644       OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1645   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1646     return overridden_method_range(nullptr, nullptr);
1647   return overridden_method_range(Pos->second.begin(), Pos->second.end());
1648 }
1649 
1650 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1651                                      const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
1652   assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
1653   OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1654 }
1655 
1656 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1657                       const NamedDecl *D,
1658                       SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
1659   assert(D);
1660 
1661   if (const auto *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
1662     Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1663                       overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
1664     return;
1665   }
1666 
1667   const auto *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1668   if (!Method)
1669     return;
1670 
1671   SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1672   Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
1673   Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
1674 }
1675 
1676 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1677   assert(!Import->getNextLocalImport() &&
1678          "Import declaration already in the chain");
1679   assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1680   if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1681     FirstLocalImport = Import;
1682     LastLocalImport = Import;
1683     return;
1684   }
1685 
1686   LastLocalImport->setNextLocalImport(Import);
1687   LastLocalImport = Import;
1688 }
1689 
1690 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1691 //                         Type Sizing and Analysis
1692 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1693 
1694 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1695 /// scalar floating point type.
1696 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
1697   switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
1698   default:
1699     llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
1700   case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
1701     return Target->getBFloat16Format();
1702   case BuiltinType::Float16:
1703   case BuiltinType::Half:
1704     return Target->getHalfFormat();
1705   case BuiltinType::Float:      return Target->getFloatFormat();
1706   case BuiltinType::Double:     return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1707   case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
1708     if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice)
1709       return AuxTarget->getLongDoubleFormat();
1710     return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
1711   case BuiltinType::Float128:
1712     if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice)
1713       return AuxTarget->getFloat128Format();
1714     return Target->getFloat128Format();
1715   }
1716 }
1717 
1718 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
1719   unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1720 
1721   bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1722   if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1723     Align = AlignFromAttr;
1724 
1725     // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1726     // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1727     // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1728     //
1729     // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
1730     // ignore that possibility;  Sema should diagnose it.
1731     if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1732       UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1733         cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1734     } else {
1735       UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1736     }
1737   }
1738   else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1739       UseAlignAttrOnly =
1740         D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1741         cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1742 
1743   // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1744   // else about the declaration and its type.
1745   if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
1746     // do nothing
1747   } else if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
1748     QualType T = VD->getType();
1749     if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
1750       if (ForAlignof)
1751         T = RT->getPointeeType();
1752       else
1753         T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1754     }
1755     QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1756     if (T->isFunctionType())
1757       Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align;
1758     else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) {
1759       // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1760       // large-array alignment on the target.
1761       if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
1762         unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1763         if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
1764           if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1765             Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1766           else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1767                    MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1768             Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1769         }
1770       }
1771       Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
1772       if (BaseT.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
1773         Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1774       if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1775         if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof) {
1776           uint64_t TypeSize = getTypeSize(T.getTypePtr());
1777           Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign(TypeSize));
1778         }
1779       }
1780     }
1781 
1782     // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1783     // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1784     // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack).  So calculate
1785     // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1786     // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
1787     if (const auto *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1788       const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1789       // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1790       if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1791         const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
1792 
1793         // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1794         unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1795 
1796         // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1797         uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1798         if (Offset > 0) {
1799           // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1800           // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1801           uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1802           if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1803             FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1804         }
1805 
1806         Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
1807       }
1808     }
1809   }
1810 
1811   // Some targets have hard limitation on the maximum requestable alignment in
1812   // aligned attribute for static variables.
1813   const unsigned MaxAlignedAttr = getTargetInfo().getMaxAlignedAttribute();
1814   const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
1815   if (MaxAlignedAttr && VD && VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static)
1816     Align = std::min(Align, MaxAlignedAttr);
1817 
1818   return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
1819 }
1820 
1821 CharUnits ASTContext::getExnObjectAlignment() const {
1822   return toCharUnitsFromBits(Target->getExnObjectAlignment());
1823 }
1824 
1825 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1826 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned.  This is
1827 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1828 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1829 TypeInfoChars ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1830   TypeInfoChars Info = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1831 
1832   // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1833   // of a base-class subobject.  We decide whether that's possible
1834   // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1835   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1836     if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1837       const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1838       Info.Width = layout.getDataSize();
1839     }
1840   }
1841 
1842   return Info;
1843 }
1844 
1845 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1846 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1847 TypeInfoChars
1848 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1849                                    const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1850   TypeInfoChars EltInfo = Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1851   uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1852   assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.Width.getQuantity()) <=
1853               (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1854          "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1855   uint64_t Width = EltInfo.Width.getQuantity() * Size;
1856   unsigned Align = EltInfo.Align.getQuantity();
1857   if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1858       Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1859     Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
1860   return TypeInfoChars(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1861                        CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align),
1862                        EltInfo.AlignIsRequired);
1863 }
1864 
1865 TypeInfoChars ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
1866   if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1867     return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
1868   TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1869   return TypeInfoChars(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1870                        toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align),
1871                        Info.AlignIsRequired);
1872 }
1873 
1874 TypeInfoChars ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
1875   return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1876 }
1877 
1878 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1879   return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1880 }
1881 
1882 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1883   return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1884 }
1885 
1886 unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T,
1887                                          bool NeedsPreferredAlignment) const {
1888   // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1889   if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1890     if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1891       return Align;
1892 
1893   // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1894   T = getBaseElementType(T);
1895   if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1896     return NeedsPreferredAlignment ? getPreferredTypeAlign(T) : getTypeAlign(T);
1897 
1898   // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1899   // type with an alignment attribute.
1900   if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1901     if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1902       return Align;
1903 
1904   // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1905   if (const auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1906     return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1907 
1908   return 0;
1909 }
1910 
1911 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1912   TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1913   if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1914     return I->second;
1915 
1916   // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1917   TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1918   MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
1919   return TI;
1920 }
1921 
1922 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits.  This
1923 /// method does not work on incomplete types.
1924 ///
1925 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1926 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1927 /// should take a QualType, &c.
1928 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1929   uint64_t Width = 0;
1930   unsigned Align = 8;
1931   bool AlignIsRequired = false;
1932   unsigned AS = 0;
1933   switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
1934 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
1935 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
1936 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
1937 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
1938 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)                       \
1939   case Type::Class:                                                            \
1940   assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here");      \
1941   return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1942 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
1943     llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
1944 
1945   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1946   case Type::FunctionProto:
1947     // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1948     Width = 0;
1949     Align = 32;
1950     break;
1951 
1952   case Type::IncompleteArray:
1953   case Type::VariableArray:
1954   case Type::ConstantArray: {
1955     // Model non-constant sized arrays as size zero, but track the alignment.
1956     uint64_t Size = 0;
1957     if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1958       Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1959 
1960     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1961     assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
1962            "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
1963     Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1964     Align = EltInfo.Align;
1965     AlignIsRequired = EltInfo.AlignIsRequired;
1966     if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1967         getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1968       Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
1969     break;
1970   }
1971 
1972   case Type::ExtVector:
1973   case Type::Vector: {
1974     const auto *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1975     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1976     Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
1977     Align = Width;
1978     // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1979     // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
1980     if (Align & (Align-1)) {
1981       Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1982       Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
1983     }
1984     // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1985     uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1986     if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1987       Align = TargetVectorAlign;
1988     if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector)
1989       // Adjust the alignment for fixed-length SVE vectors. This is important
1990       // for non-power-of-2 vector lengths.
1991       Align = 128;
1992     else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector)
1993       // Adjust the alignment for fixed-length SVE predicates.
1994       Align = 16;
1995     break;
1996   }
1997 
1998   case Type::ConstantMatrix: {
1999     const auto *MT = cast<ConstantMatrixType>(T);
2000     TypeInfo ElementInfo = getTypeInfo(MT->getElementType());
2001     // The internal layout of a matrix value is implementation defined.
2002     // Initially be ABI compatible with arrays with respect to alignment and
2003     // size.
2004     Width = ElementInfo.Width * MT->getNumRows() * MT->getNumColumns();
2005     Align = ElementInfo.Align;
2006     break;
2007   }
2008 
2009   case Type::Builtin:
2010     switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
2011     default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
2012     case BuiltinType::Void:
2013       // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
2014       Width = 0;
2015       Align = 8;
2016       break;
2017     case BuiltinType::Bool:
2018       Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
2019       Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
2020       break;
2021     case BuiltinType::Char_S:
2022     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
2023     case BuiltinType::UChar:
2024     case BuiltinType::SChar:
2025     case BuiltinType::Char8:
2026       Width = Target->getCharWidth();
2027       Align = Target->getCharAlign();
2028       break;
2029     case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
2030     case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
2031       Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
2032       Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
2033       break;
2034     case BuiltinType::Char16:
2035       Width = Target->getChar16Width();
2036       Align = Target->getChar16Align();
2037       break;
2038     case BuiltinType::Char32:
2039       Width = Target->getChar32Width();
2040       Align = Target->getChar32Align();
2041       break;
2042     case BuiltinType::UShort:
2043     case BuiltinType::Short:
2044       Width = Target->getShortWidth();
2045       Align = Target->getShortAlign();
2046       break;
2047     case BuiltinType::UInt:
2048     case BuiltinType::Int:
2049       Width = Target->getIntWidth();
2050       Align = Target->getIntAlign();
2051       break;
2052     case BuiltinType::ULong:
2053     case BuiltinType::Long:
2054       Width = Target->getLongWidth();
2055       Align = Target->getLongAlign();
2056       break;
2057     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
2058     case BuiltinType::LongLong:
2059       Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
2060       Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
2061       break;
2062     case BuiltinType::Int128:
2063     case BuiltinType::UInt128:
2064       Width = 128;
2065       Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
2066       break;
2067     case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
2068     case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
2069     case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
2070     case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
2071       Width = Target->getShortAccumWidth();
2072       Align = Target->getShortAccumAlign();
2073       break;
2074     case BuiltinType::Accum:
2075     case BuiltinType::UAccum:
2076     case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
2077     case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
2078       Width = Target->getAccumWidth();
2079       Align = Target->getAccumAlign();
2080       break;
2081     case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
2082     case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
2083     case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
2084     case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
2085       Width = Target->getLongAccumWidth();
2086       Align = Target->getLongAccumAlign();
2087       break;
2088     case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
2089     case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
2090     case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
2091     case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
2092       Width = Target->getShortFractWidth();
2093       Align = Target->getShortFractAlign();
2094       break;
2095     case BuiltinType::Fract:
2096     case BuiltinType::UFract:
2097     case BuiltinType::SatFract:
2098     case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
2099       Width = Target->getFractWidth();
2100       Align = Target->getFractAlign();
2101       break;
2102     case BuiltinType::LongFract:
2103     case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
2104     case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
2105     case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
2106       Width = Target->getLongFractWidth();
2107       Align = Target->getLongFractAlign();
2108       break;
2109     case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
2110       Width = Target->getBFloat16Width();
2111       Align = Target->getBFloat16Align();
2112       break;
2113     case BuiltinType::Float16:
2114     case BuiltinType::Half:
2115       if (Target->hasFloat16Type() || !getLangOpts().OpenMP ||
2116           !getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) {
2117         Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
2118         Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
2119       } else {
2120         assert(getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
2121                "Expected OpenMP device compilation.");
2122         Width = AuxTarget->getHalfWidth();
2123         Align = AuxTarget->getHalfAlign();
2124       }
2125       break;
2126     case BuiltinType::Float:
2127       Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
2128       Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
2129       break;
2130     case BuiltinType::Double:
2131       Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
2132       Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
2133       break;
2134     case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
2135       if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
2136           (Target->getLongDoubleWidth() != AuxTarget->getLongDoubleWidth() ||
2137            Target->getLongDoubleAlign() != AuxTarget->getLongDoubleAlign())) {
2138         Width = AuxTarget->getLongDoubleWidth();
2139         Align = AuxTarget->getLongDoubleAlign();
2140       } else {
2141         Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
2142         Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
2143       }
2144       break;
2145     case BuiltinType::Float128:
2146       if (Target->hasFloat128Type() || !getLangOpts().OpenMP ||
2147           !getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) {
2148         Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
2149         Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
2150       } else {
2151         assert(getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
2152                "Expected OpenMP device compilation.");
2153         Width = AuxTarget->getFloat128Width();
2154         Align = AuxTarget->getFloat128Align();
2155       }
2156       break;
2157     case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
2158       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
2159       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); //   == sizeof(void*)
2160       break;
2161     case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
2162     case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
2163     case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
2164       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
2165       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
2166       break;
2167     case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
2168     case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
2169     case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
2170     case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
2171     case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
2172 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
2173     case BuiltinType::Id:
2174 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
2175 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
2176   case BuiltinType::Id:
2177 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
2178       AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
2179           Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T)));
2180       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2181       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2182       break;
2183     // The SVE types are effectively target-specific.  The length of an
2184     // SVE_VECTOR_TYPE is only known at runtime, but it is always a multiple
2185     // of 128 bits.  There is one predicate bit for each vector byte, so the
2186     // length of an SVE_PREDICATE_TYPE is always a multiple of 16 bits.
2187     //
2188     // Because the length is only known at runtime, we use a dummy value
2189     // of 0 for the static length.  The alignment values are those defined
2190     // by the Procedure Call Standard for the Arm Architecture.
2191 #define SVE_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits,    \
2192                         IsSigned, IsFP, IsBF)                                  \
2193   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
2194     Width = 0;                                                                 \
2195     Align = 128;                                                               \
2196     break;
2197 #define SVE_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls)         \
2198   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
2199     Width = 0;                                                                 \
2200     Align = 16;                                                                \
2201     break;
2202 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
2203 #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size)                                        \
2204   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
2205     Width = Size;                                                              \
2206     Align = Size;                                                              \
2207     break;
2208 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
2209 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, ElKind, ElBits, NF, IsSigned,   \
2210                         IsFP)                                                  \
2211   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
2212     Width = 0;                                                                 \
2213     Align = ElBits;                                                            \
2214     break;
2215 #define RVV_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, ElKind)                      \
2216   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
2217     Width = 0;                                                                 \
2218     Align = 8;                                                                 \
2219     break;
2220 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
2221     }
2222     break;
2223   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2224     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
2225     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
2226     break;
2227   case Type::BlockPointer:
2228     AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
2229     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2230     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2231     break;
2232   case Type::LValueReference:
2233   case Type::RValueReference:
2234     // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
2235     // the pointer route.
2236     AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
2237     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2238     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2239     break;
2240   case Type::Pointer:
2241     AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
2242     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
2243     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
2244     break;
2245   case Type::MemberPointer: {
2246     const auto *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
2247     CXXABI::MemberPointerInfo MPI = ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT);
2248     Width = MPI.Width;
2249     Align = MPI.Align;
2250     break;
2251   }
2252   case Type::Complex: {
2253     // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
2254     // size.
2255     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
2256     Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
2257     Align = EltInfo.Align;
2258     break;
2259   }
2260   case Type::ObjCObject:
2261     return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
2262   case Type::Adjusted:
2263   case Type::Decayed:
2264     return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
2265   case Type::ObjCInterface: {
2266     const auto *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
2267     if (ObjCI->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
2268       Width = 8;
2269       Align = 8;
2270       break;
2271     }
2272     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
2273     Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
2274     Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
2275     break;
2276   }
2277   case Type::ExtInt: {
2278     const auto *EIT = cast<ExtIntType>(T);
2279     Align =
2280         std::min(static_cast<unsigned>(std::max(
2281                      getCharWidth(), llvm::PowerOf2Ceil(EIT->getNumBits()))),
2282                  Target->getLongLongAlign());
2283     Width = llvm::alignTo(EIT->getNumBits(), Align);
2284     break;
2285   }
2286   case Type::Record:
2287   case Type::Enum: {
2288     const auto *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
2289 
2290     if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
2291       Width = 8;
2292       Align = 8;
2293       break;
2294     }
2295 
2296     if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
2297       const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
2298       TypeInfo Info =
2299           getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
2300       if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
2301         Info.Align = AttrAlign;
2302         Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
2303       }
2304       return Info;
2305     }
2306 
2307     const auto *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
2308     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2309     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2310     Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
2311     Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
2312     AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
2313     break;
2314   }
2315 
2316   case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
2317     return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
2318                        getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
2319 
2320   case Type::Auto:
2321   case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: {
2322     const auto *A = cast<DeducedType>(T);
2323     assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
2324            "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
2325     return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
2326   }
2327 
2328   case Type::Paren:
2329     return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
2330 
2331   case Type::MacroQualified:
2332     return getTypeInfo(
2333         cast<MacroQualifiedType>(T)->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
2334 
2335   case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
2336     return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
2337 
2338   case Type::Typedef: {
2339     const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
2340     TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
2341     // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
2342     // alignment we have.  This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
2343     // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
2344     if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
2345       Align = AttrAlign;
2346       AlignIsRequired = true;
2347     } else {
2348       Align = Info.Align;
2349       AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
2350     }
2351     Width = Info.Width;
2352     break;
2353   }
2354 
2355   case Type::Elaborated:
2356     return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
2357 
2358   case Type::Attributed:
2359     return getTypeInfo(
2360                   cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
2361 
2362   case Type::Atomic: {
2363     // Start with the base type information.
2364     TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
2365     Width = Info.Width;
2366     Align = Info.Align;
2367 
2368     if (!Width) {
2369       // An otherwise zero-sized type should still generate an
2370       // atomic operation.
2371       Width = Target->getCharWidth();
2372       assert(Align);
2373     } else if (Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
2374       // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
2375       // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
2376       // favorable to atomic operations:
2377 
2378       // Round the size up to a power of 2.
2379       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
2380         Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
2381 
2382       // Set the alignment equal to the size.
2383       Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
2384     }
2385   }
2386   break;
2387 
2388   case Type::Pipe:
2389     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
2390     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
2391     break;
2392   }
2393 
2394   assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
2395   return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
2396 }
2397 
2398 unsigned ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlign(const Type *T) const {
2399   UnadjustedAlignMap::iterator I = MemoizedUnadjustedAlign.find(T);
2400   if (I != MemoizedUnadjustedAlign.end())
2401     return I->second;
2402 
2403   unsigned UnadjustedAlign;
2404   if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2405     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2406     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2407     UnadjustedAlign = toBits(Layout.getUnadjustedAlignment());
2408   } else if (const auto *ObjCI = T->getAs<ObjCInterfaceType>()) {
2409     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
2410     UnadjustedAlign = toBits(Layout.getUnadjustedAlignment());
2411   } else {
2412     UnadjustedAlign = getTypeAlign(T->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
2413   }
2414 
2415   MemoizedUnadjustedAlign[T] = UnadjustedAlign;
2416   return UnadjustedAlign;
2417 }
2418 
2419 unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
2420   unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
2421   return SimdAlign;
2422 }
2423 
2424 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
2425 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
2426   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
2427 }
2428 
2429 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
2430 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
2431   return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
2432 }
2433 
2434 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
2435 /// This method does not work on incomplete types.
2436 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
2437   return getTypeInfoInChars(T).Width;
2438 }
2439 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
2440   return getTypeInfoInChars(T).Width;
2441 }
2442 
2443 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
2444 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
2445 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
2446   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
2447 }
2448 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
2449   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
2450 }
2451 
2452 /// getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a
2453 /// type, in characters, before alignment adustments. This method does
2454 /// not work on incomplete types.
2455 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
2456   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeUnadjustedAlign(T));
2457 }
2458 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
2459   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeUnadjustedAlign(T));
2460 }
2461 
2462 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
2463 /// type for the current target in bits.  This can be different than the ABI
2464 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance or backwards
2465 /// compatibility preserving to overalign a data type. (Note: despite the name,
2466 /// the preferred alignment is ABI-impacting, and not an optimization.)
2467 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
2468   TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
2469   unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
2470 
2471   T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2472 
2473   // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
2474   if (T->isMemberPointerType())
2475     return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
2476 
2477   if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
2478     return ABIAlign;
2479 
2480   if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2481     if (TI.AlignIsRequired || RT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl())
2482       return ABIAlign;
2483 
2484     unsigned PreferredAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(
2485         toBits(getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl()).PreferredAlignment));
2486     assert(PreferredAlign >= ABIAlign &&
2487            "PreferredAlign should be at least as large as ABIAlign.");
2488     return PreferredAlign;
2489   }
2490 
2491   // Double (and, for targets supporting AIX `power` alignment, long double) and
2492   // long long should be naturally aligned (despite requiring less alignment) if
2493   // possible.
2494   if (const auto *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
2495     T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
2496   if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2497     T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
2498   if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
2499       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2500       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) ||
2501       (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongDouble) &&
2502        Target->defaultsToAIXPowerAlignment()))
2503     // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2504     // typedef declaration.
2505     if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
2506       return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
2507 
2508   return ABIAlign;
2509 }
2510 
2511 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2512 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2513 /// value is specified.
2514 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
2515   return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2516 }
2517 
2518 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2519 /// to a global variable of the specified type.
2520 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
2521   uint64_t TypeSize = getTypeSize(T.getTypePtr());
2522   return std::max(getPreferredTypeAlign(T),
2523                   getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign(TypeSize));
2524 }
2525 
2526 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2527 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
2528 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
2529   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
2530 }
2531 
2532 CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2533   CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2534   const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2535   while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2536     Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2537     Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2538   }
2539   return Offset;
2540 }
2541 
2542 CharUnits ASTContext::getMemberPointerPathAdjustment(const APValue &MP) const {
2543   const ValueDecl *MPD = MP.getMemberPointerDecl();
2544   CharUnits ThisAdjustment = CharUnits::Zero();
2545   ArrayRef<const CXXRecordDecl*> Path = MP.getMemberPointerPath();
2546   bool DerivedMember = MP.isMemberPointerToDerivedMember();
2547   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(MPD->getDeclContext());
2548   for (unsigned I = 0, N = Path.size(); I != N; ++I) {
2549     const CXXRecordDecl *Base = RD;
2550     const CXXRecordDecl *Derived = Path[I];
2551     if (DerivedMember)
2552       std::swap(Base, Derived);
2553     ThisAdjustment += getASTRecordLayout(Derived).getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2554     RD = Path[I];
2555   }
2556   if (DerivedMember)
2557     ThisAdjustment = -ThisAdjustment;
2558   return ThisAdjustment;
2559 }
2560 
2561 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2562 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2563 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2564 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2565 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
2566 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2567                                       bool leafClass,
2568                             SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
2569   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2570     DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2571   if (!leafClass) {
2572     for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
2573       Ivars.push_back(I);
2574   } else {
2575     auto *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
2576     for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
2577          Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2578       Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2579   }
2580 }
2581 
2582 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2583 /// those inherited by it.
2584 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
2585                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
2586   if (const auto *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
2587     // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2588     // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
2589     for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
2590       CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
2591     }
2592 
2593     // Categories of this Interface.
2594     for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2595       CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
2596 
2597     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2598       while (SD) {
2599         CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2600         SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2601       }
2602   } else if (const auto *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
2603     for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
2604       CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
2605     }
2606   } else if (const auto *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
2607     // Insert the protocol.
2608     if (!Protocols.insert(
2609           const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2610       return;
2611 
2612     for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2613       CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
2614   }
2615 }
2616 
2617 static bool unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2618                                                 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2619   assert(RD->isUnion() && "Must be union type");
2620   CharUnits UnionSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(RD->getTypeForDecl());
2621 
2622   for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2623     if (!Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2624       return false;
2625     CharUnits FieldSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType());
2626     if (FieldSize != UnionSize)
2627       return false;
2628   }
2629   return !RD->field_empty();
2630 }
2631 
2632 static bool isStructEmpty(QualType Ty) {
2633   const RecordDecl *RD = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2634 
2635   if (!RD->field_empty())
2636     return false;
2637 
2638   if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
2639     return ClassDecl->isEmpty();
2640 
2641   return true;
2642 }
2643 
2644 static llvm::Optional<int64_t>
2645 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2646                                      const RecordDecl *RD) {
2647   assert(!RD->isUnion() && "Must be struct/class type");
2648   const auto &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2649 
2650   int64_t CurOffsetInBits = 0;
2651   if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2652     if (ClassDecl->isDynamicClass())
2653       return llvm::None;
2654 
2655     SmallVector<std::pair<QualType, int64_t>, 4> Bases;
2656     for (const auto &Base : ClassDecl->bases()) {
2657       // Empty types can be inherited from, and non-empty types can potentially
2658       // have tail padding, so just make sure there isn't an error.
2659       if (!isStructEmpty(Base.getType())) {
2660         llvm::Optional<int64_t> Size = structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2661             Context, Base.getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2662         if (!Size)
2663           return llvm::None;
2664         Bases.emplace_back(Base.getType(), Size.getValue());
2665       }
2666     }
2667 
2668     llvm::sort(Bases, [&](const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &L,
2669                           const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &R) {
2670       return Layout.getBaseClassOffset(L.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) <
2671              Layout.getBaseClassOffset(R.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
2672     });
2673 
2674     for (const auto &Base : Bases) {
2675       int64_t BaseOffset = Context.toBits(
2676           Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()));
2677       int64_t BaseSize = Base.second;
2678       if (BaseOffset != CurOffsetInBits)
2679         return llvm::None;
2680       CurOffsetInBits = BaseOffset + BaseSize;
2681     }
2682   }
2683 
2684   for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2685     if (!Field->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
2686         !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2687       return llvm::None;
2688 
2689     int64_t FieldSizeInBits =
2690         Context.toBits(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType()));
2691     if (Field->isBitField()) {
2692       int64_t BitfieldSize = Field->getBitWidthValue(Context);
2693 
2694       if (BitfieldSize > FieldSizeInBits)
2695         return llvm::None;
2696       FieldSizeInBits = BitfieldSize;
2697     }
2698 
2699     int64_t FieldOffsetInBits = Context.getFieldOffset(Field);
2700 
2701     if (FieldOffsetInBits != CurOffsetInBits)
2702       return llvm::None;
2703 
2704     CurOffsetInBits = FieldSizeInBits + FieldOffsetInBits;
2705   }
2706 
2707   return CurOffsetInBits;
2708 }
2709 
2710 bool ASTContext::hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(QualType Ty) const {
2711   // C++17 [meta.unary.prop]:
2712   //   The predicate condition for a template specialization
2713   //   has_unique_object_representations<T> shall be
2714   //   satisfied if and only if:
2715   //     (9.1) - T is trivially copyable, and
2716   //     (9.2) - any two objects of type T with the same value have the same
2717   //     object representation, where two objects
2718   //   of array or non-union class type are considered to have the same value
2719   //   if their respective sequences of
2720   //   direct subobjects have the same values, and two objects of union type
2721   //   are considered to have the same
2722   //   value if they have the same active member and the corresponding members
2723   //   have the same value.
2724   //   The set of scalar types for which this condition holds is
2725   //   implementation-defined. [ Note: If a type has padding
2726   //   bits, the condition does not hold; otherwise, the condition holds true
2727   //   for unsigned integral types. -- end note ]
2728   assert(!Ty.isNull() && "Null QualType sent to unique object rep check");
2729 
2730   // Arrays are unique only if their element type is unique.
2731   if (Ty->isArrayType())
2732     return hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(getBaseElementType(Ty));
2733 
2734   // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable...
2735   if (!Ty.isTriviallyCopyableType(*this))
2736     return false;
2737 
2738   // All integrals and enums are unique.
2739   if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
2740     return true;
2741 
2742   // All other pointers are unique.
2743   if (Ty->isPointerType())
2744     return true;
2745 
2746   if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
2747     const auto *MPT = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2748     return !ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT).HasPadding;
2749   }
2750 
2751   if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
2752     const RecordDecl *Record = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2753 
2754     if (Record->isInvalidDecl())
2755       return false;
2756 
2757     if (Record->isUnion())
2758       return unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2759 
2760     Optional<int64_t> StructSize =
2761         structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2762 
2763     return StructSize &&
2764            StructSize.getValue() == static_cast<int64_t>(getTypeSize(Ty));
2765   }
2766 
2767   // FIXME: More cases to handle here (list by rsmith):
2768   // vectors (careful about, eg, vector of 3 foo)
2769   // _Complex int and friends
2770   // _Atomic T
2771   // Obj-C block pointers
2772   // Obj-C object pointers
2773   // and perhaps OpenCL's various builtin types (pipe, sampler_t, event_t,
2774   // clk_event_t, queue_t, reserve_id_t)
2775   // There're also Obj-C class types and the Obj-C selector type, but I think it
2776   // makes sense for those to return false here.
2777 
2778   return false;
2779 }
2780 
2781 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
2782   unsigned count = 0;
2783   // Count ivars declared in class extension.
2784   for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
2785     count += Ext->ivar_size();
2786 
2787   // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation.  This
2788   // includes synthesized ivars.
2789   if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
2790     count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2791 
2792   return count;
2793 }
2794 
2795 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2796   if (!E)
2797     return false;
2798 
2799   // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2800   if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2801 
2802   if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2803       E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2804                                                 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2805     return true;
2806 
2807   // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2808   if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2809 
2810   return false;
2811 }
2812 
2813 /// Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl, or nullptr if none
2814 /// exists.
2815 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2816   llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2817     I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2818   if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2819     return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
2820   return nullptr;
2821 }
2822 
2823 /// Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or nullptr if none
2824 /// exists.
2825 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2826   llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2827     I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2828   if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2829     return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
2830   return nullptr;
2831 }
2832 
2833 /// Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2834 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2835                            ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2836   assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2837   ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2838 }
2839 
2840 /// Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2841 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2842                            ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2843   assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2844   ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2845 }
2846 
2847 const ObjCMethodDecl *
2848 ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2849   return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2850 }
2851 
2852 void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2853                                             const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2854   assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2855   ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2856 }
2857 
2858 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2859                                               const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2860   if (const auto *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2861     return ID;
2862   if (const auto *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2863     return CD->getClassInterface();
2864   if (const auto *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2865     return IMD->getClassInterface();
2866 
2867   return nullptr;
2868 }
2869 
2870 /// Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl, or nullptr if
2871 /// none exists.
2872 BlockVarCopyInit ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl *VD) const {
2873   assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2874   assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2875          "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2876   auto I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
2877   if (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end())
2878     return I->second;
2879   return {nullptr, false};
2880 }
2881 
2882 /// Set the copy initialization expression of a block var decl.
2883 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInit(const VarDecl*VD, Expr *CopyExpr,
2884                                      bool CanThrow) {
2885   assert(VD && CopyExpr && "Passed null params");
2886   assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2887          "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2888   BlockVarCopyInits[VD].setExprAndFlag(CopyExpr, CanThrow);
2889 }
2890 
2891 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2892                                                  unsigned DataSize) const {
2893   if (!DataSize)
2894     DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2895   else
2896     assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
2897            "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
2898 
2899   auto *TInfo =
2900     (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2901   new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2902   return TInfo;
2903 }
2904 
2905 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2906                                                      SourceLocation L) const {
2907   TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
2908   DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
2909   return DI;
2910 }
2911 
2912 const ASTRecordLayout &
2913 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
2914   return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
2915 }
2916 
2917 const ASTRecordLayout &
2918 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2919                                         const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
2920   return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2921 }
2922 
2923 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2924 //                   Type creation/memoization methods
2925 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2926 
2927 QualType
2928 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2929   unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2930   quals.removeFastQualifiers();
2931 
2932   // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2933   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2934   ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
2935   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2936   if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2937     assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2938     return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2939   }
2940 
2941   // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2942   QualType canon;
2943   if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2944     SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
2945     canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2946     canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
2947 
2948     // Re-find the insert position.
2949     (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2950   }
2951 
2952   auto *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2953   ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2954   return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2955 }
2956 
2957 QualType ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,
2958                                           LangAS AddressSpace) const {
2959   QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2960   if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
2961     return T;
2962 
2963   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2964   // into one ExtQuals node.
2965   QualifierCollector Quals;
2966   const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2967 
2968   // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2969   // another one.
2970   assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2971          "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2972   Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
2973 
2974   return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2975 }
2976 
2977 QualType ASTContext::removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const {
2978   // If the type is not qualified with an address space, just return it
2979   // immediately.
2980   if (!T.hasAddressSpace())
2981     return T;
2982 
2983   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2984   // into one ExtQuals node.
2985   QualifierCollector Quals;
2986   const Type *TypeNode;
2987 
2988   while (T.hasAddressSpace()) {
2989     TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2990 
2991     // If the type no longer has an address space after stripping qualifiers,
2992     // jump out.
2993     if (!QualType(TypeNode, 0).hasAddressSpace())
2994       break;
2995 
2996     // There might be sugar in the way. Strip it and try again.
2997     T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(*this);
2998   }
2999 
3000   Quals.removeAddressSpace();
3001 
3002   // Removal of the address space can mean there are no longer any
3003   // non-fast qualifiers, so creating an ExtQualType isn't possible (asserts)
3004   // or required.
3005   if (Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers())
3006     return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
3007   else
3008     return QualType(TypeNode, Quals.getFastQualifiers());
3009 }
3010 
3011 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
3012                                        Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
3013   QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
3014   if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
3015     return T;
3016 
3017   if (const auto *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3018     QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
3019     if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
3020       QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
3021       return getPointerType(ResultType);
3022     }
3023   }
3024 
3025   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
3026   // into one ExtQuals node.
3027   QualifierCollector Quals;
3028   const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
3029 
3030   // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
3031   // another one.
3032   assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
3033          "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
3034   Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
3035 
3036   return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
3037 }
3038 
3039 QualType ASTContext::removePtrSizeAddrSpace(QualType T) const {
3040   if (const PointerType *Ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3041     QualType Pointee = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3042     if (isPtrSizeAddressSpace(Pointee.getAddressSpace())) {
3043       return getPointerType(removeAddrSpaceQualType(Pointee));
3044     }
3045   }
3046   return T;
3047 }
3048 
3049 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
3050                                                    FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
3051   if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
3052     return T;
3053 
3054   QualType Result;
3055   if (const auto *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
3056     Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
3057   } else {
3058     const auto *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
3059     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
3060     EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
3061     Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
3062   }
3063 
3064   return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
3065 }
3066 
3067 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
3068                                                  QualType ResultType) {
3069   FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
3070   while (true) {
3071     const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3072     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
3073     FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
3074     if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
3075       FD = Next;
3076     else
3077       break;
3078   }
3079   if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
3080     L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
3081 }
3082 
3083 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
3084 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
3085 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
3086 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
3087 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
3088     QualType Orig, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
3089   // Might have some parens.
3090   if (const auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
3091     return getParenType(
3092         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
3093 
3094   // Might be wrapped in a macro qualified type.
3095   if (const auto *MQT = dyn_cast<MacroQualifiedType>(Orig))
3096     return getMacroQualifiedType(
3097         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(MQT->getUnderlyingType(), ESI),
3098         MQT->getMacroIdentifier());
3099 
3100   // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
3101   if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
3102     return getAttributedType(
3103         AT->getAttrKind(),
3104         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
3105         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(AT->getEquivalentType(), ESI));
3106 
3107   // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
3108   // specification.
3109   const auto *Proto = Orig->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3110   return getFunctionType(
3111       Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
3112       Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
3113 }
3114 
3115 bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,
3116                                                           QualType U) {
3117   return hasSameType(T, U) ||
3118          (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
3119           hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(T, EST_None),
3120                       getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(U, EST_None)));
3121 }
3122 
3123 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(QualType T) {
3124   if (const auto *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3125     QualType RetTy = removePtrSizeAddrSpace(Proto->getReturnType());
3126     SmallVector<QualType, 16> Args(Proto->param_types());
3127     for (unsigned i = 0, n = Args.size(); i != n; ++i)
3128       Args[i] = removePtrSizeAddrSpace(Args[i]);
3129     return getFunctionType(RetTy, Args, Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
3130   }
3131 
3132   if (const FunctionNoProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionNoProtoType>()) {
3133     QualType RetTy = removePtrSizeAddrSpace(Proto->getReturnType());
3134     return getFunctionNoProtoType(RetTy, Proto->getExtInfo());
3135   }
3136 
3137   return T;
3138 }
3139 
3140 bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(QualType T, QualType U) {
3141   return hasSameType(T, U) ||
3142          hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(T),
3143                      getFunctionTypeWithoutPtrSizes(U));
3144 }
3145 
3146 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
3147     FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
3148     bool AsWritten) {
3149   // Update the type.
3150   QualType Updated =
3151       getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(FD->getType(), ESI);
3152   FD->setType(Updated);
3153 
3154   if (!AsWritten)
3155     return;
3156 
3157   // Update the type in the type source information too.
3158   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
3159     // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
3160     // the type-as-written too.
3161     if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
3162       Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
3163 
3164     // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
3165     // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
3166     // up the TypeSourceInfo;
3167     assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
3168                TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
3169            "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
3170     TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
3171   }
3172 }
3173 
3174 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
3175 /// number with the specified element type.
3176 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
3177   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3178   // structure.
3179   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3180   ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
3181 
3182   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3183   if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3184     return QualType(CT, 0);
3185 
3186   // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3187   // so fill in the canonical type field.
3188   QualType Canonical;
3189   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3190     Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
3191 
3192     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3193     ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3194     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3195   }
3196   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
3197   Types.push_back(New);
3198   ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3199   return QualType(New, 0);
3200 }
3201 
3202 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
3203 /// the specified type.
3204 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
3205   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3206   // structure.
3207   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3208   PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
3209 
3210   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3211   if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3212     return QualType(PT, 0);
3213 
3214   // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3215   // so fill in the canonical type field.
3216   QualType Canonical;
3217   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3218     Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
3219 
3220     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3221     PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3222     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3223   }
3224   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
3225   Types.push_back(New);
3226   PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3227   return QualType(New, 0);
3228 }
3229 
3230 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
3231   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3232   AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
3233   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3234   AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3235   if (AT)
3236     return QualType(AT, 0);
3237 
3238   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
3239 
3240   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3241   AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3242   assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3243 
3244   AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3245       AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
3246   Types.push_back(AT);
3247   AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3248   return QualType(AT, 0);
3249 }
3250 
3251 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
3252   assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
3253 
3254   QualType Decayed;
3255 
3256   // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
3257   //   A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
3258   //   adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
3259   //   qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
3260   //   the array type derivation.
3261   if (T->isArrayType())
3262     Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
3263 
3264   // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
3265   //   A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
3266   //   shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
3267   //   in 6.3.2.1.
3268   if (T->isFunctionType())
3269     Decayed = getPointerType(T);
3270 
3271   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3272   AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
3273   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3274   AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3275   if (AT)
3276     return QualType(AT, 0);
3277 
3278   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
3279 
3280   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3281   AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3282   assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3283 
3284   AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
3285   Types.push_back(AT);
3286   AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3287   return QualType(AT, 0);
3288 }
3289 
3290 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
3291 /// a pointer to the specified block.
3292 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
3293   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
3294   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
3295   // structure.
3296   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3297   BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
3298 
3299   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3300   if (BlockPointerType *PT =
3301         BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3302     return QualType(PT, 0);
3303 
3304   // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
3305   // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
3306   QualType Canonical;
3307   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3308     Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
3309 
3310     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3311     BlockPointerType *NewIP =
3312       BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3313     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3314   }
3315   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
3316   Types.push_back(New);
3317   BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3318   return QualType(New, 0);
3319 }
3320 
3321 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
3322 /// lvalue reference to the specified type.
3323 QualType
3324 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
3325   assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
3326          "Unresolved overloaded function type");
3327 
3328   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3329   // structure.
3330   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3331   ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
3332 
3333   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3334   if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
3335         LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3336     return QualType(RT, 0);
3337 
3338   const auto *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3339 
3340   // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3341   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3342   QualType Canonical;
3343   if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
3344     QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
3345     Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
3346 
3347     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3348     LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
3349       LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3350     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3351   }
3352 
3353   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
3354                                                              SpelledAsLValue);
3355   Types.push_back(New);
3356   LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3357 
3358   return QualType(New, 0);
3359 }
3360 
3361 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
3362 /// rvalue reference to the specified type.
3363 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
3364   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3365   // structure.
3366   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3367   ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
3368 
3369   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3370   if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
3371         RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3372     return QualType(RT, 0);
3373 
3374   const auto *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3375 
3376   // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3377   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3378   QualType Canonical;
3379   if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
3380     QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
3381     Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
3382 
3383     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3384     RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
3385       RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3386     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3387   }
3388 
3389   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
3390   Types.push_back(New);
3391   RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3392   return QualType(New, 0);
3393 }
3394 
3395 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
3396 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
3397 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
3398   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3399   // structure.
3400   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3401   MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
3402 
3403   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3404   if (MemberPointerType *PT =
3405       MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3406     return QualType(PT, 0);
3407 
3408   // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
3409   // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3410   QualType Canonical;
3411   if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3412     Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
3413 
3414     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3415     MemberPointerType *NewIP =
3416       MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3417     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3418   }
3419   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
3420   Types.push_back(New);
3421   MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3422   return QualType(New, 0);
3423 }
3424 
3425 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
3426 /// array of the specified element type.
3427 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
3428                                           const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
3429                                           const Expr *SizeExpr,
3430                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
3431                                           unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
3432   assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
3433           EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
3434          "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
3435 
3436   // We only need the size as part of the type if it's instantiation-dependent.
3437   if (SizeExpr && !SizeExpr->isInstantiationDependent())
3438     SizeExpr = nullptr;
3439 
3440   // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
3441   // the target.
3442   llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
3443   ArySize = ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getMaxPointerWidth());
3444 
3445   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3446   ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, *this, EltTy, ArySize, SizeExpr, ASM,
3447                              IndexTypeQuals);
3448 
3449   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3450   if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
3451       ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3452     return QualType(ATP, 0);
3453 
3454   // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, or the array bound
3455   // is instantiation-dependent, this won't be a canonical type either, so fill
3456   // in the canonical type field.
3457   QualType Canon;
3458   if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers() || SizeExpr) {
3459     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
3460     Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize, nullptr,
3461                                  ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
3462     Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
3463 
3464     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3465     ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
3466       ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3467     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3468   }
3469 
3470   void *Mem = Allocate(
3471       ConstantArrayType::totalSizeToAlloc<const Expr *>(SizeExpr ? 1 : 0),
3472       TypeAlignment);
3473   auto *New = new (Mem)
3474     ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, SizeExpr, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
3475   ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3476   Types.push_back(New);
3477   return QualType(New, 0);
3478 }
3479 
3480 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
3481 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
3482 /// sizes replaced with [*].
3483 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
3484   // Vastly most common case.
3485   if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
3486 
3487   QualType result;
3488 
3489   SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
3490   const Type *ty = split.Ty;
3491   switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
3492 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
3493 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
3494 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
3495 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
3496     llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
3497 
3498   // These types should never be variably-modified.
3499   case Type::Builtin:
3500   case Type::Complex:
3501   case Type::Vector:
3502   case Type::DependentVector:
3503   case Type::ExtVector:
3504   case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
3505   case Type::ConstantMatrix:
3506   case Type::DependentSizedMatrix:
3507   case Type::DependentAddressSpace:
3508   case Type::ObjCObject:
3509   case Type::ObjCInterface:
3510   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
3511   case Type::Record:
3512   case Type::Enum:
3513   case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
3514   case Type::TypeOfExpr:
3515   case Type::TypeOf:
3516   case Type::Decltype:
3517   case Type::UnaryTransform:
3518   case Type::DependentName:
3519   case Type::InjectedClassName:
3520   case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
3521   case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
3522   case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
3523   case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
3524   case Type::Auto:
3525   case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
3526   case Type::PackExpansion:
3527   case Type::ExtInt:
3528   case Type::DependentExtInt:
3529     llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
3530 
3531   // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
3532   // further decay.
3533   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
3534   case Type::FunctionProto:
3535   case Type::BlockPointer:
3536   case Type::MemberPointer:
3537   case Type::Pipe:
3538     return type;
3539 
3540   // These types can be variably-modified.  All these modifications
3541   // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
3542   // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
3543   // optimizations available here.
3544   case Type::Pointer:
3545     result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
3546                               cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
3547     break;
3548 
3549   case Type::LValueReference: {
3550     const auto *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
3551     result = getLValueReferenceType(
3552                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
3553                                     lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
3554     break;
3555   }
3556 
3557   case Type::RValueReference: {
3558     const auto *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
3559     result = getRValueReferenceType(
3560                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
3561     break;
3562   }
3563 
3564   case Type::Atomic: {
3565     const auto *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
3566     result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
3567     break;
3568   }
3569 
3570   case Type::ConstantArray: {
3571     const auto *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
3572     result = getConstantArrayType(
3573                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
3574                                   cat->getSize(),
3575                                   cat->getSizeExpr(),
3576                                   cat->getSizeModifier(),
3577                                   cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
3578     break;
3579   }
3580 
3581   case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
3582     const auto *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
3583     result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
3584                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
3585                                         dat->getSizeExpr(),
3586                                         dat->getSizeModifier(),
3587                                         dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3588                                         dat->getBracketsRange());
3589     break;
3590   }
3591 
3592   // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
3593   case Type::IncompleteArray: {
3594     const auto *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
3595     result = getVariableArrayType(
3596                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
3597                                   /*size*/ nullptr,
3598                                   ArrayType::Normal,
3599                                   iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3600                                   SourceRange());
3601     break;
3602   }
3603 
3604   // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
3605   case Type::VariableArray: {
3606     const auto *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
3607     result = getVariableArrayType(
3608                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
3609                                   /*size*/ nullptr,
3610                                   ArrayType::Star,
3611                                   vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3612                                   vat->getBracketsRange());
3613     break;
3614   }
3615   }
3616 
3617   // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
3618   return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
3619 }
3620 
3621 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
3622 /// variable array of the specified element type.
3623 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
3624                                           Expr *NumElts,
3625                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
3626                                           unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
3627                                           SourceRange Brackets) const {
3628   // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
3629   // that have an expression provided for their size.
3630   QualType Canon;
3631 
3632   // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
3633   if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3634     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
3635     Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
3636                                  IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
3637     Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
3638   }
3639 
3640   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3641     VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
3642 
3643   VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
3644   Types.push_back(New);
3645   return QualType(New, 0);
3646 }
3647 
3648 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
3649 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
3650 /// type.
3651 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
3652                                                 Expr *numElements,
3653                                                 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
3654                                                 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
3655                                                 SourceRange brackets) const {
3656   assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
3657           numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
3658          "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
3659 
3660   // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
3661   // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
3662   // initializer.  We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
3663   // because they can't be used in most locations.
3664   if (!numElements) {
3665     auto *newType
3666       = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3667           DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
3668                                   numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3669                                   brackets);
3670     Types.push_back(newType);
3671     return QualType(newType, 0);
3672   }
3673 
3674   // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
3675   // also build a canonical type.
3676 
3677   SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
3678 
3679   void *insertPos = nullptr;
3680   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3681   DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
3682                                    QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
3683                                    ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
3684 
3685   // Look for an existing type with these properties.
3686   DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
3687     DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3688 
3689   // If we don't have one, build one.
3690   if (!canonTy) {
3691     canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3692       DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
3693                               QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3694                               brackets);
3695     DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3696     Types.push_back(canonTy);
3697   }
3698 
3699   // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
3700   QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
3701                                     canonElementType.Quals);
3702 
3703   // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
3704   // expression, then just use that as our result.
3705   if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
3706       canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
3707     return canon;
3708 
3709   // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
3710   // of the element type.
3711   auto *sugaredType
3712     = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3713         DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
3714                                 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
3715   Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3716   return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
3717 }
3718 
3719 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
3720                                             ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
3721                                             unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
3722   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3723   IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
3724 
3725   void *insertPos = nullptr;
3726   if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
3727        IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
3728     return QualType(iat, 0);
3729 
3730   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3731   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.  We also have to pull
3732   // qualifiers off the element type.
3733   QualType canon;
3734 
3735   if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3736     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
3737     canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
3738                                    ASM, elementTypeQuals);
3739     canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
3740 
3741     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3742     IncompleteArrayType *existing =
3743       IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3744     assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
3745   }
3746 
3747   auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3748     IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
3749 
3750   IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
3751   Types.push_back(newType);
3752   return QualType(newType, 0);
3753 }
3754 
3755 ASTContext::BuiltinVectorTypeInfo
3756 ASTContext::getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(const BuiltinType *Ty) const {
3757 #define SVE_INT_ELTTY(BITS, ELTS, SIGNED, NUMVECTORS)                          \
3758   {getIntTypeForBitwidth(BITS, SIGNED), llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(ELTS), \
3759    NUMVECTORS};
3760 
3761 #define SVE_ELTTY(ELTTY, ELTS, NUMVECTORS)                                     \
3762   {ELTTY, llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(ELTS), NUMVECTORS};
3763 
3764   switch (Ty->getKind()) {
3765   default:
3766     llvm_unreachable("Unsupported builtin vector type");
3767   case BuiltinType::SveInt8:
3768     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 1);
3769   case BuiltinType::SveUint8:
3770     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 1);
3771   case BuiltinType::SveInt8x2:
3772     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 2);
3773   case BuiltinType::SveUint8x2:
3774     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 2);
3775   case BuiltinType::SveInt8x3:
3776     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 3);
3777   case BuiltinType::SveUint8x3:
3778     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 3);
3779   case BuiltinType::SveInt8x4:
3780     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, true, 4);
3781   case BuiltinType::SveUint8x4:
3782     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(8, 16, false, 4);
3783   case BuiltinType::SveInt16:
3784     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 1);
3785   case BuiltinType::SveUint16:
3786     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 1);
3787   case BuiltinType::SveInt16x2:
3788     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 2);
3789   case BuiltinType::SveUint16x2:
3790     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 2);
3791   case BuiltinType::SveInt16x3:
3792     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 3);
3793   case BuiltinType::SveUint16x3:
3794     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 3);
3795   case BuiltinType::SveInt16x4:
3796     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, true, 4);
3797   case BuiltinType::SveUint16x4:
3798     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(16, 8, false, 4);
3799   case BuiltinType::SveInt32:
3800     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 1);
3801   case BuiltinType::SveUint32:
3802     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 1);
3803   case BuiltinType::SveInt32x2:
3804     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 2);
3805   case BuiltinType::SveUint32x2:
3806     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 2);
3807   case BuiltinType::SveInt32x3:
3808     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 3);
3809   case BuiltinType::SveUint32x3:
3810     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 3);
3811   case BuiltinType::SveInt32x4:
3812     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, true, 4);
3813   case BuiltinType::SveUint32x4:
3814     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(32, 4, false, 4);
3815   case BuiltinType::SveInt64:
3816     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 1);
3817   case BuiltinType::SveUint64:
3818     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 1);
3819   case BuiltinType::SveInt64x2:
3820     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 2);
3821   case BuiltinType::SveUint64x2:
3822     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 2);
3823   case BuiltinType::SveInt64x3:
3824     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 3);
3825   case BuiltinType::SveUint64x3:
3826     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 3);
3827   case BuiltinType::SveInt64x4:
3828     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, true, 4);
3829   case BuiltinType::SveUint64x4:
3830     return SVE_INT_ELTTY(64, 2, false, 4);
3831   case BuiltinType::SveBool:
3832     return SVE_ELTTY(BoolTy, 16, 1);
3833   case BuiltinType::SveFloat16:
3834     return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 1);
3835   case BuiltinType::SveFloat16x2:
3836     return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 2);
3837   case BuiltinType::SveFloat16x3:
3838     return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 3);
3839   case BuiltinType::SveFloat16x4:
3840     return SVE_ELTTY(HalfTy, 8, 4);
3841   case BuiltinType::SveFloat32:
3842     return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 1);
3843   case BuiltinType::SveFloat32x2:
3844     return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 2);
3845   case BuiltinType::SveFloat32x3:
3846     return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 3);
3847   case BuiltinType::SveFloat32x4:
3848     return SVE_ELTTY(FloatTy, 4, 4);
3849   case BuiltinType::SveFloat64:
3850     return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 1);
3851   case BuiltinType::SveFloat64x2:
3852     return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 2);
3853   case BuiltinType::SveFloat64x3:
3854     return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 3);
3855   case BuiltinType::SveFloat64x4:
3856     return SVE_ELTTY(DoubleTy, 2, 4);
3857   case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16:
3858     return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 1);
3859   case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16x2:
3860     return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 2);
3861   case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16x3:
3862     return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 3);
3863   case BuiltinType::SveBFloat16x4:
3864     return SVE_ELTTY(BFloat16Ty, 8, 4);
3865 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE_INT(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF,         \
3866                             IsSigned)                                          \
3867   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
3868     return {getIntTypeForBitwidth(ElBits, IsSigned),                           \
3869             llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), NF};
3870 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE_FLOAT(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF)       \
3871   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
3872     return {ElBits == 16 ? HalfTy : (ElBits == 32 ? FloatTy : DoubleTy),       \
3873             llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), NF};
3874 #define RVV_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls)                      \
3875   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
3876     return {BoolTy, llvm::ElementCount::getScalable(NumEls), 1};
3877 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
3878   }
3879 }
3880 
3881 /// getScalableVectorType - Return the unique reference to a scalable vector
3882 /// type of the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in
3883 /// type.
3884 QualType ASTContext::getScalableVectorType(QualType EltTy,
3885                                            unsigned NumElts) const {
3886   if (Target->hasAArch64SVETypes()) {
3887     uint64_t EltTySize = getTypeSize(EltTy);
3888 #define SVE_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits,    \
3889                         IsSigned, IsFP, IsBF)                                  \
3890   if (!EltTy->isBooleanType() &&                                               \
3891       ((EltTy->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&                                   \
3892         EltTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() == IsSigned) ||                \
3893        (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && !EltTy->isBFloat16Type() &&      \
3894         IsFP && !IsBF) ||                                                      \
3895        (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && EltTy->isBFloat16Type() &&       \
3896         IsBF && !IsFP)) &&                                                     \
3897       EltTySize == ElBits && NumElts == NumEls) {                              \
3898     return SingletonId;                                                        \
3899   }
3900 #define SVE_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, MangledName, Id, SingletonId, NumEls)         \
3901   if (EltTy->isBooleanType() && NumElts == NumEls)                             \
3902     return SingletonId;
3903 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
3904   } else if (Target->hasRISCVVTypes()) {
3905     uint64_t EltTySize = getTypeSize(EltTy);
3906 #define RVV_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls, ElBits, NF, IsSigned,   \
3907                         IsFP)                                                  \
3908     if (!EltTy->isBooleanType() &&                                             \
3909         ((EltTy->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&                                 \
3910           EltTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() == IsSigned) ||              \
3911          (EltTy->hasFloatingRepresentation() && IsFP)) &&                      \
3912         EltTySize == ElBits && NumElts == NumEls)                              \
3913       return SingletonId;
3914 #define RVV_PREDICATE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId, NumEls)                      \
3915     if (EltTy->isBooleanType() && NumElts == NumEls)                           \
3916       return SingletonId;
3917 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
3918   }
3919   return QualType();
3920 }
3921 
3922 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
3923 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
3924 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
3925                                    VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
3926   assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
3927 
3928   // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3929   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3930   VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
3931 
3932   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3933   if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3934     return QualType(VTP, 0);
3935 
3936   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3937   // so fill in the canonical type field.
3938   QualType Canonical;
3939   if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
3940     Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
3941 
3942     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3943     VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3944     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3945   }
3946   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3947     VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
3948   VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3949   Types.push_back(New);
3950   return QualType(New, 0);
3951 }
3952 
3953 QualType
3954 ASTContext::getDependentVectorType(QualType VecType, Expr *SizeExpr,
3955                                    SourceLocation AttrLoc,
3956                                    VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
3957   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3958   DependentVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(VecType), SizeExpr,
3959                                VecKind);
3960   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3961   DependentVectorType *Canon =
3962       DependentVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3963   DependentVectorType *New;
3964 
3965   if (Canon) {
3966     New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentVectorType(
3967         *this, VecType, QualType(Canon, 0), SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind);
3968   } else {
3969     QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(VecType);
3970     if (CanonVecTy == VecType) {
3971       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentVectorType(
3972           *this, VecType, QualType(), SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind);
3973 
3974       DependentVectorType *CanonCheck =
3975           DependentVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3976       assert(!CanonCheck &&
3977              "Dependent-sized vector_size canonical type broken");
3978       (void)CanonCheck;
3979       DependentVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3980     } else {
3981       QualType CanonTy = getDependentVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
3982                                                 SourceLocation(), VecKind);
3983       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentVectorType(
3984           *this, VecType, CanonTy, SizeExpr, AttrLoc, VecKind);
3985     }
3986   }
3987 
3988   Types.push_back(New);
3989   return QualType(New, 0);
3990 }
3991 
3992 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
3993 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
3994 QualType
3995 ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
3996   assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
3997 
3998   // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3999   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4000   VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
4001                       VectorType::GenericVector);
4002   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4003   if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4004     return QualType(VTP, 0);
4005 
4006   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
4007   // so fill in the canonical type field.
4008   QualType Canonical;
4009   if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
4010     Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
4011 
4012     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4013     VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4014     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4015   }
4016   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4017     ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
4018   VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4019   Types.push_back(New);
4020   return QualType(New, 0);
4021 }
4022 
4023 QualType
4024 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
4025                                            Expr *SizeExpr,
4026                                            SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
4027   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4028   DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
4029                                        SizeExpr);
4030 
4031   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4032   DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
4033     = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4034   DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
4035   if (Canon) {
4036     // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
4037     // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
4038     New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4039       DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
4040                                   SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
4041   } else {
4042     QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
4043     if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
4044       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4045         DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
4046                                     AttrLoc);
4047 
4048       DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
4049         = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4050       assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
4051       (void)CanonCheck;
4052       DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4053     } else {
4054       QualType CanonExtTy = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
4055                                                            SourceLocation());
4056       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentSizedExtVectorType(
4057           *this, vecType, CanonExtTy, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
4058     }
4059   }
4060 
4061   Types.push_back(New);
4062   return QualType(New, 0);
4063 }
4064 
4065 QualType ASTContext::getConstantMatrixType(QualType ElementTy, unsigned NumRows,
4066                                            unsigned NumColumns) const {
4067   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4068   ConstantMatrixType::Profile(ID, ElementTy, NumRows, NumColumns,
4069                               Type::ConstantMatrix);
4070 
4071   assert(MatrixType::isValidElementType(ElementTy) &&
4072          "need a valid element type");
4073   assert(ConstantMatrixType::isDimensionValid(NumRows) &&
4074          ConstantMatrixType::isDimensionValid(NumColumns) &&
4075          "need valid matrix dimensions");
4076   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4077   if (ConstantMatrixType *MTP = MatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4078     return QualType(MTP, 0);
4079 
4080   QualType Canonical;
4081   if (!ElementTy.isCanonical()) {
4082     Canonical =
4083         getConstantMatrixType(getCanonicalType(ElementTy), NumRows, NumColumns);
4084 
4085     ConstantMatrixType *NewIP = MatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4086     assert(!NewIP && "Matrix type shouldn't already exist in the map");
4087     (void)NewIP;
4088   }
4089 
4090   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4091       ConstantMatrixType(ElementTy, NumRows, NumColumns, Canonical);
4092   MatrixTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4093   Types.push_back(New);
4094   return QualType(New, 0);
4095 }
4096 
4097 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedMatrixType(QualType ElementTy,
4098                                                  Expr *RowExpr,
4099                                                  Expr *ColumnExpr,
4100                                                  SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
4101   QualType CanonElementTy = getCanonicalType(ElementTy);
4102   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4103   DependentSizedMatrixType::Profile(ID, *this, CanonElementTy, RowExpr,
4104                                     ColumnExpr);
4105 
4106   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4107   DependentSizedMatrixType *Canon =
4108       DependentSizedMatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4109 
4110   if (!Canon) {
4111     Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentSizedMatrixType(
4112         *this, CanonElementTy, QualType(), RowExpr, ColumnExpr, AttrLoc);
4113 #ifndef NDEBUG
4114     DependentSizedMatrixType *CanonCheck =
4115         DependentSizedMatrixTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4116     assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized matrix canonical type broken");
4117 #endif
4118     DependentSizedMatrixTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4119     Types.push_back(Canon);
4120   }
4121 
4122   // Already have a canonical version of the matrix type
4123   //
4124   // If it exactly matches the requested type, use it directly.
4125   if (Canon->getElementType() == ElementTy && Canon->getRowExpr() == RowExpr &&
4126       Canon->getRowExpr() == ColumnExpr)
4127     return QualType(Canon, 0);
4128 
4129   // Use Canon as the canonical type for newly-built type.
4130   DependentSizedMatrixType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4131       DependentSizedMatrixType(*this, ElementTy, QualType(Canon, 0), RowExpr,
4132                                ColumnExpr, AttrLoc);
4133   Types.push_back(New);
4134   return QualType(New, 0);
4135 }
4136 
4137 QualType ASTContext::getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType,
4138                                                   Expr *AddrSpaceExpr,
4139                                                   SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
4140   assert(AddrSpaceExpr->isInstantiationDependent());
4141 
4142   QualType canonPointeeType = getCanonicalType(PointeeType);
4143 
4144   void *insertPos = nullptr;
4145   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4146   DependentAddressSpaceType::Profile(ID, *this, canonPointeeType,
4147                                      AddrSpaceExpr);
4148 
4149   DependentAddressSpaceType *canonTy =
4150     DependentAddressSpaceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
4151 
4152   if (!canonTy) {
4153     canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4154       DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, canonPointeeType,
4155                                 QualType(), AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
4156     DependentAddressSpaceTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
4157     Types.push_back(canonTy);
4158   }
4159 
4160   if (canonPointeeType == PointeeType &&
4161       canonTy->getAddrSpaceExpr() == AddrSpaceExpr)
4162     return QualType(canonTy, 0);
4163 
4164   auto *sugaredType
4165     = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4166         DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, PointeeType, QualType(canonTy, 0),
4167                                   AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
4168   Types.push_back(sugaredType);
4169   return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
4170 }
4171 
4172 /// Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
4173 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
4174   return T.isCanonical() &&
4175          (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
4176           T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
4177 }
4178 
4179 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
4180 QualType
4181 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
4182                                    const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
4183   // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
4184   // structure.
4185   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4186   FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
4187 
4188   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4189   if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
4190         FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4191     return QualType(FT, 0);
4192 
4193   QualType Canonical;
4194   if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
4195     Canonical =
4196       getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
4197 
4198     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4199     FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
4200       FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4201     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4202   }
4203 
4204   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4205     FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
4206   Types.push_back(New);
4207   FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4208   return QualType(New, 0);
4209 }
4210 
4211 CanQualType
4212 ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
4213   CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
4214 
4215   // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
4216   if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
4217     Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
4218     Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
4219     return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
4220              getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
4221   }
4222 
4223   return CanResultType;
4224 }
4225 
4226 static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
4227     const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
4228   if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
4229     return true;
4230   if (!NoexceptInType)
4231     return false;
4232 
4233   // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
4234   // boolean "can this function type throw".
4235   if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
4236     return true;
4237 
4238   // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
4239   // value-dependent.
4240   if (ESI.Type == EST_DependentNoexcept)
4241     return true;
4242 
4243   // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
4244   // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
4245   // contained types are canonical.
4246   if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
4247     bool AnyPackExpansions = false;
4248     for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) {
4249       if (!ET.isCanonical())
4250         return false;
4251       if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
4252         AnyPackExpansions = true;
4253     }
4254     return AnyPackExpansions;
4255   }
4256 
4257   return false;
4258 }
4259 
4260 QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
4261     QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
4262     const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
4263   size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
4264 
4265   // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
4266   // structure.
4267   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4268   FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
4269                              *this, true);
4270 
4271   QualType Canonical;
4272   bool Unique = false;
4273 
4274   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4275   if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
4276         FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
4277     QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
4278 
4279     // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
4280     // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
4281     // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
4282     // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
4283     // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
4284     if (OnlyWantCanonical || !isComputedNoexcept(EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) ||
4285         EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
4286       return Existing;
4287 
4288     // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
4289     // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
4290     // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
4291     Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
4292     Unique = true;
4293   }
4294 
4295   bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
4296   bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
4297       isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
4298 
4299   // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
4300   bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
4301                      isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
4302   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
4303     if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
4304       isCanonical = false;
4305 
4306   if (OnlyWantCanonical)
4307     assert(isCanonical &&
4308            "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
4309 
4310   // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
4311   // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
4312   // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
4313   if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
4314     SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
4315     CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
4316     for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
4317       CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
4318 
4319     llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
4320     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
4321     CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
4322 
4323     if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
4324       // Exception spec is already OK.
4325     } else if (NoexceptInType) {
4326       switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
4327       case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
4328         // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
4329         // should ever look at this.
4330         LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
4331       case EST_None: case EST_MSAny: case EST_NoexceptFalse:
4332         CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
4333         break;
4334 
4335         // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
4336         // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
4337       case EST_Dynamic: {
4338         bool AnyPacks = false;
4339         for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
4340           if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
4341             AnyPacks = true;
4342           ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
4343         }
4344         if (!AnyPacks)
4345           CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
4346         else {
4347           CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
4348           CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
4349         }
4350         break;
4351       }
4352 
4353       case EST_DynamicNone:
4354       case EST_BasicNoexcept:
4355       case EST_NoexceptTrue:
4356       case EST_NoThrow:
4357         CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
4358         break;
4359 
4360       case EST_DependentNoexcept:
4361         llvm_unreachable("dependent noexcept is already canonical");
4362       }
4363     } else {
4364       CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
4365     }
4366 
4367     // Adjust the canonical function result type.
4368     CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
4369     Canonical =
4370         getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
4371 
4372     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4373     FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
4374       FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4375     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
4376   }
4377 
4378   // Compute the needed size to hold this FunctionProtoType and the
4379   // various trailing objects.
4380   auto ESH = FunctionProtoType::getExceptionSpecSize(
4381       EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type, EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size());
4382   size_t Size = FunctionProtoType::totalSizeToAlloc<
4383       QualType, SourceLocation, FunctionType::FunctionTypeExtraBitfields,
4384       FunctionType::ExceptionType, Expr *, FunctionDecl *,
4385       FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, Qualifiers>(
4386       NumArgs, EPI.Variadic,
4387       FunctionProtoType::hasExtraBitfields(EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type),
4388       ESH.NumExceptionType, ESH.NumExprPtr, ESH.NumFunctionDeclPtr,
4389       EPI.ExtParameterInfos ? NumArgs : 0,
4390       EPI.TypeQuals.hasNonFastQualifiers() ? 1 : 0);
4391 
4392   auto *FTP = (FunctionProtoType *)Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
4393   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
4394   new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
4395   Types.push_back(FTP);
4396   if (!Unique)
4397     FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
4398   return QualType(FTP, 0);
4399 }
4400 
4401 QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const {
4402   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4403   PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly);
4404 
4405   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4406   if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4407     return QualType(PT, 0);
4408 
4409   // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4410   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4411   QualType Canonical;
4412   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4413     Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly);
4414 
4415     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4416     PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4417     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
4418     (void)NewIP;
4419   }
4420   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly);
4421   Types.push_back(New);
4422   PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4423   return QualType(New, 0);
4424 }
4425 
4426 QualType ASTContext::adjustStringLiteralBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
4427   // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space.
4428   return LangOpts.OpenCL ? getAddrSpaceQualType(Ty, LangAS::opencl_constant)
4429                          : Ty;
4430 }
4431 
4432 QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const {
4433   return getPipeType(T, true);
4434 }
4435 
4436 QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const {
4437   return getPipeType(T, false);
4438 }
4439 
4440 QualType ASTContext::getExtIntType(bool IsUnsigned, unsigned NumBits) const {
4441   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4442   ExtIntType::Profile(ID, IsUnsigned, NumBits);
4443 
4444   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4445   if (ExtIntType *EIT = ExtIntTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4446     return QualType(EIT, 0);
4447 
4448   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtIntType(IsUnsigned, NumBits);
4449   ExtIntTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4450   Types.push_back(New);
4451   return QualType(New, 0);
4452 }
4453 
4454 QualType ASTContext::getDependentExtIntType(bool IsUnsigned,
4455                                             Expr *NumBitsExpr) const {
4456   assert(NumBitsExpr->isInstantiationDependent() && "Only good for dependent");
4457   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4458   DependentExtIntType::Profile(ID, *this, IsUnsigned, NumBitsExpr);
4459 
4460   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4461   if (DependentExtIntType *Existing =
4462           DependentExtIntTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4463     return QualType(Existing, 0);
4464 
4465   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4466       DependentExtIntType(*this, IsUnsigned, NumBitsExpr);
4467   DependentExtIntTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4468 
4469   Types.push_back(New);
4470   return QualType(New, 0);
4471 }
4472 
4473 #ifndef NDEBUG
4474 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
4475   if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
4476   const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
4477   if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
4478     return true;
4479   if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
4480       !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
4481     return true;
4482   return false;
4483 }
4484 #endif
4485 
4486 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
4487 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
4488 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
4489                                               QualType TST) const {
4490   assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
4491   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
4492     assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
4493   } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
4494     assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
4495     Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
4496     assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
4497   } else {
4498     Type *newType =
4499       new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
4500     Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
4501     Types.push_back(newType);
4502   }
4503   return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4504 }
4505 
4506 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4507 /// specified type declaration.
4508 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
4509   assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
4510   assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
4511 
4512   if (const auto *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
4513     return getTypedefType(Typedef);
4514 
4515   assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
4516          "Template type parameter types are always available.");
4517 
4518   if (const auto *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
4519     assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
4520     assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
4521     return getRecordType(Record);
4522   } else if (const auto *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
4523     assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
4524     return getEnumType(Enum);
4525   } else if (const auto *Using = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
4526     Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
4527     Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
4528     Types.push_back(newType);
4529   } else
4530     llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
4531 
4532   return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4533 }
4534 
4535 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4536 /// specified typedef name decl.
4537 QualType ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
4538                                     QualType Underlying) const {
4539   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4540 
4541   if (Underlying.isNull())
4542     Underlying = Decl->getUnderlyingType();
4543   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
4544   auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4545       TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Underlying, Canonical);
4546   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
4547   Types.push_back(newType);
4548   return QualType(newType, 0);
4549 }
4550 
4551 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
4552   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4553 
4554   if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
4555     if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
4556       return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4557 
4558   auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
4559   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
4560   Types.push_back(newType);
4561   return QualType(newType, 0);
4562 }
4563 
4564 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
4565   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4566 
4567   if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
4568     if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
4569       return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4570 
4571   auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
4572   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
4573   Types.push_back(newType);
4574   return QualType(newType, 0);
4575 }
4576 
4577 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(attr::Kind attrKind,
4578                                        QualType modifiedType,
4579                                        QualType equivalentType) {
4580   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
4581   AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
4582 
4583   void *insertPos = nullptr;
4584   AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
4585   if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
4586 
4587   QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
4588   type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4589       AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
4590 
4591   Types.push_back(type);
4592   AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
4593 
4594   return QualType(type, 0);
4595 }
4596 
4597 /// Retrieve a substitution-result type.
4598 QualType
4599 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
4600                                          QualType Replacement) const {
4601   assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
4602          && "replacement types must always be canonical");
4603 
4604   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4605   SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
4606   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4607   SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
4608     = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4609 
4610   if (!SubstParm) {
4611     SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4612       SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
4613     Types.push_back(SubstParm);
4614     SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
4615   }
4616 
4617   return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
4618 }
4619 
4620 /// Retrieve a
4621 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
4622                                           const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
4623                                               const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
4624 #ifndef NDEBUG
4625   for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
4626     assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
4627     assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
4628   }
4629 #endif
4630 
4631   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4632   SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
4633   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4634   if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
4635         = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4636     return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
4637 
4638   QualType Canon;
4639   if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
4640     Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
4641     Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
4642                                              ArgPack);
4643     SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4644   }
4645 
4646   auto *SubstParm
4647     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
4648                                                                ArgPack);
4649   Types.push_back(SubstParm);
4650   SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
4651   return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
4652 }
4653 
4654 /// Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
4655 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
4656 /// name.
4657 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
4658                                              bool ParameterPack,
4659                                              TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
4660   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4661   TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
4662   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4663   TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
4664     = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4665 
4666   if (TypeParm)
4667     return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
4668 
4669   if (TTPDecl) {
4670     QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
4671     TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
4672 
4673     TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
4674       = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4675     assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
4676     (void)TypeCheck;
4677   } else
4678     TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4679       TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
4680 
4681   Types.push_back(TypeParm);
4682   TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
4683 
4684   return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
4685 }
4686 
4687 TypeSourceInfo *
4688 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
4689                                               SourceLocation NameLoc,
4690                                         const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
4691                                               QualType Underlying) const {
4692   assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
4693          "No dependent template names here!");
4694   QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
4695 
4696   TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
4697   TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
4698       DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
4699   TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
4700   TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
4701   TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
4702   TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
4703   for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
4704     TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
4705   return DI;
4706 }
4707 
4708 QualType
4709 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
4710                                           const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
4711                                           QualType Underlying) const {
4712   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
4713          "No dependent template names here!");
4714 
4715   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
4716   ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
4717   for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
4718     ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
4719 
4720   return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
4721 }
4722 
4723 #ifndef NDEBUG
4724 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
4725   for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
4726     if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
4727       return true;
4728 
4729   return true;
4730 }
4731 #endif
4732 
4733 QualType
4734 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
4735                                           ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
4736                                           QualType Underlying) const {
4737   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
4738          "No dependent template names here!");
4739   // Look through qualified template names.
4740   if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
4741     Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
4742 
4743   bool IsTypeAlias =
4744     Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
4745     isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
4746   QualType CanonType;
4747   if (!Underlying.isNull())
4748     CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
4749   else {
4750     // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
4751     // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
4752     assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
4753            "Caller must compute aliased type");
4754     IsTypeAlias = false;
4755     CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
4756   }
4757 
4758   // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
4759   // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
4760   // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
4761   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
4762                        sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
4763                        (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
4764                        TypeAlignment);
4765   auto *Spec
4766     = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
4767                                          IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
4768 
4769   Types.push_back(Spec);
4770   return QualType(Spec, 0);
4771 }
4772 
4773 QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
4774     TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
4775   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
4776          "No dependent template names here!");
4777 
4778   // Look through qualified template names.
4779   if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
4780     Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
4781 
4782   // Build the canonical template specialization type.
4783   TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
4784   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
4785   unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
4786   CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
4787   for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
4788     CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
4789 
4790   // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
4791   // exists.
4792   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4793   TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
4794                                       CanonArgs, *this);
4795 
4796   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4797   TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
4798     = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4799 
4800   if (!Spec) {
4801     // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
4802     void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
4803                           sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
4804                          TypeAlignment);
4805     Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
4806                                                 CanonArgs,
4807                                                 QualType(), QualType());
4808     Types.push_back(Spec);
4809     TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
4810   }
4811 
4812   assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
4813          "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
4814   return QualType(Spec, 0);
4815 }
4816 
4817 QualType ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4818                                        NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4819                                        QualType NamedType,
4820                                        TagDecl *OwnedTagDecl) const {
4821   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4822   ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType, OwnedTagDecl);
4823 
4824   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4825   ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4826   if (T)
4827     return QualType(T, 0);
4828 
4829   QualType Canon = NamedType;
4830   if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4831     Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
4832     ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4833     assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
4834     (void)CheckT;
4835   }
4836 
4837   void *Mem = Allocate(ElaboratedType::totalSizeToAlloc<TagDecl *>(!!OwnedTagDecl),
4838                        TypeAlignment);
4839   T = new (Mem) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon, OwnedTagDecl);
4840 
4841   Types.push_back(T);
4842   ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4843   return QualType(T, 0);
4844 }
4845 
4846 QualType
4847 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
4848   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4849   ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
4850 
4851   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4852   ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4853   if (T)
4854     return QualType(T, 0);
4855 
4856   QualType Canon = InnerType;
4857   if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4858     Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
4859     ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4860     assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
4861     (void)CheckT;
4862   }
4863 
4864   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
4865   Types.push_back(T);
4866   ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4867   return QualType(T, 0);
4868 }
4869 
4870 QualType
4871 ASTContext::getMacroQualifiedType(QualType UnderlyingTy,
4872                                   const IdentifierInfo *MacroII) const {
4873   QualType Canon = UnderlyingTy;
4874   if (!Canon.isCanonical())
4875     Canon = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingTy);
4876 
4877   auto *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4878       MacroQualifiedType(UnderlyingTy, Canon, MacroII);
4879   Types.push_back(newType);
4880   return QualType(newType, 0);
4881 }
4882 
4883 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4884                                           NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4885                                           const IdentifierInfo *Name,
4886                                           QualType Canon) const {
4887   if (Canon.isNull()) {
4888     NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
4889     if (CanonNNS != NNS)
4890       Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name);
4891   }
4892 
4893   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4894   DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
4895 
4896   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4897   DependentNameType *T
4898     = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4899   if (T)
4900     return QualType(T, 0);
4901 
4902   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
4903   Types.push_back(T);
4904   DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4905   return QualType(T, 0);
4906 }
4907 
4908 QualType
4909 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4910                                  ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4911                                  NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4912                                  const IdentifierInfo *Name,
4913                                  const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
4914   // TODO: avoid this copy
4915   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
4916   for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
4917     ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
4918   return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
4919 }
4920 
4921 QualType
4922 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4923                                  ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4924                                  NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4925                                  const IdentifierInfo *Name,
4926                                  ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
4927   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
4928          "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
4929 
4930   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4931   DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
4932                                                Name, Args);
4933 
4934   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4935   DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
4936     = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4937   if (T)
4938     return QualType(T, 0);
4939 
4940   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
4941 
4942   ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
4943   if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
4944 
4945   bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
4946   unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
4947   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
4948   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
4949     CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
4950     if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
4951       AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
4952   }
4953 
4954   QualType Canon;
4955   if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
4956     Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
4957                                                    Name,
4958                                                    CanonArgs);
4959 
4960     // Find the insert position again.
4961     DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4962   }
4963 
4964   void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
4965                         sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
4966                        TypeAlignment);
4967   T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
4968                                                     Name, Args, Canon);
4969   Types.push_back(T);
4970   DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4971   return QualType(T, 0);
4972 }
4973 
4974 TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) {
4975   TemplateArgument Arg;
4976   if (const auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) {
4977     QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP);
4978     if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4979       ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, None);
4980 
4981     Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType);
4982   } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) {
4983     QualType T =
4984         NTTP->getType().getNonPackExpansionType().getNonLValueExprType(*this);
4985     // For class NTTPs, ensure we include the 'const' so the type matches that
4986     // of a real template argument.
4987     // FIXME: It would be more faithful to model this as something like an
4988     // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion applied to a const-qualified lvalue.
4989     if (T->isRecordType())
4990       T.addConst();
4991     Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr(
4992         *this, NTTP, /*enclosing*/ false, T,
4993         Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation());
4994 
4995     if (NTTP->isParameterPack())
4996       E = new (*this) PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(),
4997                                         None);
4998     Arg = TemplateArgument(E);
4999   } else {
5000     auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param);
5001     if (TTP->isParameterPack())
5002       Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP), Optional<unsigned>());
5003     else
5004       Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP));
5005   }
5006 
5007   if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack())
5008     Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg);
5009 
5010   return Arg;
5011 }
5012 
5013 void
5014 ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
5015                                     SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) {
5016   Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size());
5017 
5018   for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params)
5019     Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param));
5020 }
5021 
5022 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
5023                                           Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions,
5024                                           bool ExpectPackInType) {
5025   assert((!ExpectPackInType || Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) &&
5026          "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
5027 
5028   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5029   PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
5030 
5031   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5032   PackExpansionType *T = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5033   if (T)
5034     return QualType(T, 0);
5035 
5036   QualType Canon;
5037   if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
5038     Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions,
5039                                  /*ExpectPackInType=*/false);
5040 
5041     // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
5042     // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
5043     PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5044   }
5045 
5046   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
5047       PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
5048   Types.push_back(T);
5049   PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5050   return QualType(T, 0);
5051 }
5052 
5053 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
5054 /// alphabetically.
5055 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
5056                             ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
5057   return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
5058 }
5059 
5060 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
5061   if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
5062 
5063   if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
5064     return false;
5065 
5066   for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
5067     if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
5068         Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
5069       return false;
5070   return true;
5071 }
5072 
5073 static void
5074 SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
5075   // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
5076   llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
5077 
5078   // Canonicalize.
5079   for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
5080     P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
5081 
5082   // Remove duplicates.
5083   auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
5084   Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
5085 }
5086 
5087 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
5088                                        ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
5089                                        unsigned NumProtocols) const {
5090   return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, {},
5091                            llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
5092                            /*isKindOf=*/false);
5093 }
5094 
5095 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
5096            QualType baseType,
5097            ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
5098            ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
5099            bool isKindOf) const {
5100   // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
5101   // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
5102   if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
5103       isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
5104     return baseType;
5105 
5106   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5107   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5108   ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
5109   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5110   if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5111     return QualType(QT, 0);
5112 
5113   // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
5114   // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
5115   // type.
5116   ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
5117   if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
5118     if (const auto *baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
5119       effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
5120   }
5121 
5122   // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
5123   // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
5124   // canonicalized.
5125   QualType canonical;
5126   bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
5127                                           effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
5128                                           [&](QualType type) {
5129                                             return type.isCanonical();
5130                                           });
5131   bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
5132   if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
5133     // Determine the canonical type arguments.
5134     ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
5135     SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
5136     if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
5137       canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
5138       for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
5139         canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
5140       canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
5141     } else {
5142       canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
5143     }
5144 
5145     ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
5146     SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
5147     if (!protocolsSorted) {
5148       canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
5149       SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
5150       canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
5151     } else {
5152       canonProtocols = protocols;
5153     }
5154 
5155     canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
5156                                   canonProtocols, isKindOf);
5157 
5158     // Regenerate InsertPos.
5159     ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5160   }
5161 
5162   unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
5163   size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
5164   size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
5165   void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
5166   auto *T =
5167     new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
5168                                  isKindOf);
5169 
5170   Types.push_back(T);
5171   ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
5172   return QualType(T, 0);
5173 }
5174 
5175 /// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
5176 /// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
5177 /// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
5178 QualType
5179 ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
5180                   ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
5181                   bool allowOnPointerType) const {
5182   hasError = false;
5183 
5184   if (const auto *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
5185     return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
5186   }
5187 
5188   // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
5189   if (allowOnPointerType) {
5190     if (const auto *objPtr =
5191             dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
5192       const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
5193       // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
5194       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
5195       protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
5196                           objT->qual_end());
5197       protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
5198       ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
5199       type = getObjCObjectType(
5200              objT->getBaseType(),
5201              objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
5202              protocols,
5203              objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
5204       return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
5205     }
5206   }
5207 
5208   // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
5209   if (const auto *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
5210     // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
5211     // known to conform.
5212 
5213     return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
5214                              objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
5215                              protocols,
5216                              objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
5217   }
5218 
5219   // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
5220   if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
5221     // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
5222     // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
5223 
5224     // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
5225     // known to conform.
5226     return getObjCObjectType(type, {}, protocols, false);
5227   }
5228 
5229   // id<protocol-list>
5230   if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
5231     const auto *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5232     type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, protocols,
5233                                  objPtr->isKindOfType());
5234     return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
5235   }
5236 
5237   // Class<protocol-list>
5238   if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
5239     const auto *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5240     type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, protocols,
5241                                  objPtr->isKindOfType());
5242     return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
5243   }
5244 
5245   hasError = true;
5246   return type;
5247 }
5248 
5249 QualType
5250 ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
5251                                  ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols) const {
5252   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5253   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5254   ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, Decl->getUnderlyingType(), protocols);
5255   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5256   if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
5257       ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5258     return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
5259 
5260   // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
5261   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
5262   if (!protocols.empty()) {
5263     // Apply the protocol qualifers.
5264     bool hasError;
5265     Canonical = getCanonicalType(applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(
5266         Canonical, protocols, hasError, true /*allowOnPointerType*/));
5267     assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
5268   }
5269 
5270   unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
5271   size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
5272   void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
5273   auto *newType = new (mem) ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
5274 
5275   Types.push_back(newType);
5276   ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
5277   return QualType(newType, 0);
5278 }
5279 
5280 void ASTContext::adjustObjCTypeParamBoundType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Orig,
5281                                               ObjCTypeParamDecl *New) const {
5282   New->setTypeSourceInfo(getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Orig->getUnderlyingType()));
5283   // Update TypeForDecl after updating TypeSourceInfo.
5284   auto NewTypeParamTy = cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(New->getTypeForDecl());
5285   SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> protocols;
5286   protocols.append(NewTypeParamTy->qual_begin(), NewTypeParamTy->qual_end());
5287   QualType UpdatedTy = getObjCTypeParamType(New, protocols);
5288   New->setTypeForDecl(UpdatedTy.getTypePtr());
5289 }
5290 
5291 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
5292 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
5293 /// list.
5294 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
5295                                                 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
5296   if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5297     return false;
5298 
5299   if (const auto *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5300     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
5301     for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5302       if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
5303         return false;
5304     }
5305     return true;
5306   }
5307   return false;
5308 }
5309 
5310 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
5311 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
5312 /// of protocols.
5313 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
5314                                                 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
5315   if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5316     return false;
5317   const auto *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5318   if (!OPT)
5319     return false;
5320   if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
5321     return false;
5322   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
5323   CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
5324   if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
5325     return false;
5326   // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protocol
5327   // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
5328   bool Conforms = false;
5329   for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5330     Conforms = false;
5331     for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
5332       if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
5333         Conforms = true;
5334         break;
5335       }
5336     }
5337     if (!Conforms)
5338       break;
5339   }
5340   if (Conforms)
5341     return true;
5342 
5343   for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
5344     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
5345     bool Adopts = false;
5346     for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
5347       // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
5348       if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
5349         break;
5350     }
5351     if (!Adopts)
5352       return false;
5353   }
5354   return true;
5355 }
5356 
5357 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
5358 /// the given object type.
5359 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
5360   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5361   ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
5362 
5363   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5364   if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
5365               ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5366     return QualType(QT, 0);
5367 
5368   // Find the canonical object type.
5369   QualType Canonical;
5370   if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
5371     Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
5372 
5373     // Regenerate InsertPos.
5374     ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5375   }
5376 
5377   // No match.
5378   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
5379   auto *QType =
5380     new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
5381 
5382   Types.push_back(QType);
5383   ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
5384   return QualType(QType, 0);
5385 }
5386 
5387 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
5388 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
5389 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
5390                                           ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
5391   if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
5392     return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5393 
5394   if (PrevDecl) {
5395     assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
5396     Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
5397     return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
5398   }
5399 
5400   // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
5401   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
5402     Decl = Def;
5403 
5404   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
5405   auto *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
5406   Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
5407   Types.push_back(T);
5408   return QualType(T, 0);
5409 }
5410 
5411 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
5412 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
5413 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
5414 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
5415 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
5416 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
5417   TypeOfExprType *toe;
5418   if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
5419     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5420     DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
5421 
5422     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5423     DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
5424       = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5425     if (Canon) {
5426       // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
5427       // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
5428       toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
5429                                           QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
5430     } else {
5431       // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
5432       Canon
5433         = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
5434       DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
5435       toe = Canon;
5436     }
5437   } else {
5438     QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
5439     toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
5440   }
5441   Types.push_back(toe);
5442   return QualType(toe, 0);
5443 }
5444 
5445 /// getTypeOfType -  Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
5446 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
5447 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
5448 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
5449 /// on canonical types (which are always unique).
5450 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
5451   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
5452   auto *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
5453   Types.push_back(tot);
5454   return QualType(tot, 0);
5455 }
5456 
5457 /// Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
5458 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
5459 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
5460 /// is an Expr tree under each such type.
5461 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
5462   DecltypeType *dt;
5463 
5464   // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
5465   //   If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
5466   //   unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
5467   //   type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
5468   if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
5469     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5470     DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
5471 
5472     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5473     DependentDecltypeType *Canon
5474       = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5475     if (!Canon) {
5476       // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type.
5477       Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
5478       DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
5479     }
5480     dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
5481         DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
5482   } else {
5483     dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
5484         DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
5485   }
5486   Types.push_back(dt);
5487   return QualType(dt, 0);
5488 }
5489 
5490 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
5491 /// savings are minimal and these are rare.
5492 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
5493                                            QualType UnderlyingType,
5494                                            UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
5495     const {
5496   UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
5497 
5498   if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
5499     // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5500     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5501     DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
5502 
5503     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5504     DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
5505       = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5506 
5507     if (!Canon) {
5508       // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
5509       Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
5510              DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
5511                                          Kind);
5512       DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
5513     }
5514     ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
5515                                                         QualType(), Kind,
5516                                                         QualType(Canon, 0));
5517   } else {
5518     QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
5519     ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
5520                                                         UnderlyingType, Kind,
5521                                                         CanonType);
5522   }
5523   Types.push_back(ut);
5524   return QualType(ut, 0);
5525 }
5526 
5527 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
5528 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
5529 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
5530 QualType
5531 ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
5532                         bool IsDependent, bool IsPack,
5533                         ConceptDecl *TypeConstraintConcept,
5534                         ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TypeConstraintArgs) const {
5535   assert((!IsPack || IsDependent) && "only use IsPack for a dependent pack");
5536   if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto &&
5537       !TypeConstraintConcept && !IsDependent)
5538     return getAutoDeductType();
5539 
5540   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5541   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5542   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5543   AutoType::Profile(ID, *this, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent,
5544                     TypeConstraintConcept, TypeConstraintArgs);
5545   if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5546     return QualType(AT, 0);
5547 
5548   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AutoType) +
5549                        sizeof(TemplateArgument) * TypeConstraintArgs.size(),
5550                        TypeAlignment);
5551   auto *AT = new (Mem) AutoType(
5552       DeducedType, Keyword,
5553       (IsDependent ? TypeDependence::DependentInstantiation
5554                    : TypeDependence::None) |
5555           (IsPack ? TypeDependence::UnexpandedPack : TypeDependence::None),
5556       TypeConstraintConcept, TypeConstraintArgs);
5557   Types.push_back(AT);
5558   if (InsertPos)
5559     AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
5560   return QualType(AT, 0);
5561 }
5562 
5563 /// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type
5564 /// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced
5565 /// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type.
5566 QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(
5567     TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const {
5568   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
5569   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5570   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5571   DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType,
5572                                              IsDependent);
5573   if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST =
5574           DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5575     return QualType(DTST, 0);
5576 
5577   auto *DTST = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
5578       DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent);
5579   Types.push_back(DTST);
5580   if (InsertPos)
5581     DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos);
5582   return QualType(DTST, 0);
5583 }
5584 
5585 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
5586 /// the given value type.
5587 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
5588   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
5589   // structure.
5590   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
5591   AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
5592 
5593   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
5594   if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
5595     return QualType(AT, 0);
5596 
5597   // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
5598   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
5599   QualType Canonical;
5600   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
5601     Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
5602 
5603     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
5604     AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
5605     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
5606   }
5607   auto *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
5608   Types.push_back(New);
5609   AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
5610   return QualType(New, 0);
5611 }
5612 
5613 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
5614 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
5615   if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
5616     AutoDeductTy = QualType(new (*this, TypeAlignment)
5617                                 AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
5618                                          TypeDependence::None,
5619                                          /*concept*/ nullptr, /*args*/ {}),
5620                             0);
5621   return AutoDeductTy;
5622 }
5623 
5624 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
5625 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
5626   if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
5627     AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
5628   assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
5629   return AutoRRefDeductTy;
5630 }
5631 
5632 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
5633 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
5634 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
5635   assert(Decl);
5636   // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
5637   // away const?  mutable?
5638   return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
5639 }
5640 
5641 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
5642 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
5643 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
5644 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
5645   return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
5646 }
5647 
5648 /// Return the unique signed counterpart of the integer type
5649 /// corresponding to size_t.
5650 CanQualType ASTContext::getSignedSizeType() const {
5651   return getFromTargetType(Target->getSignedSizeType());
5652 }
5653 
5654 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
5655 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
5656   return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
5657 }
5658 
5659 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
5660 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
5661   return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
5662 }
5663 
5664 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
5665 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
5666 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
5667   // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
5668   return WCharTy;
5669 }
5670 
5671 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
5672 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
5673 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
5674   // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
5675   return UnsignedIntTy;
5676 }
5677 
5678 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
5679   return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
5680 }
5681 
5682 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
5683   return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
5684 }
5685 
5686 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
5687 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
5688 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
5689   return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
5690 }
5691 
5692 /// Return the unique unsigned counterpart of "ptrdiff_t"
5693 /// integer type. The standard (C11 7.21.6.1p7) refers to this type
5694 /// in the definition of %tu format specifier.
5695 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const {
5696   return getFromTargetType(Target->getUnsignedPtrDiffType(0));
5697 }
5698 
5699 /// Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
5700 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
5701 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
5702   return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
5703 }
5704 
5705 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5706 //                              Type Operators
5707 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5708 
5709 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
5710   // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
5711   // qualifiers.
5712   T = getCanonicalType(T);
5713   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5714   const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
5715   QualType Result;
5716   if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
5717     Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
5718   } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
5719     Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
5720   } else {
5721     Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
5722   }
5723 
5724   return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
5725 }
5726 
5727 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
5728                                              Qualifiers &quals) {
5729   SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
5730 
5731   // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
5732   // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
5733   // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
5734   // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
5735   const auto *AT =
5736       dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
5737 
5738   // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
5739   if (!AT) {
5740     quals = splitType.Quals;
5741     return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
5742   }
5743 
5744   // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
5745   QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
5746   QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
5747 
5748   // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
5749   // can just use the results in splitType.
5750   if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
5751     assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
5752     quals = splitType.Quals;
5753     return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
5754   }
5755 
5756   // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
5757   // build the type back up.
5758   quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
5759 
5760   if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
5761     return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
5762                                 CAT->getSizeExpr(), CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
5763   }
5764 
5765   if (const auto *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
5766     return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
5767   }
5768 
5769   if (const auto *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
5770     return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
5771                                 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
5772                                 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
5773                                 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
5774                                 VAT->getBracketsRange());
5775   }
5776 
5777   const auto *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
5778   return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
5779                                     DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
5780                                     SourceRange());
5781 }
5782 
5783 /// Attempt to unwrap two types that may both be array types with the same bound
5784 /// (or both be array types of unknown bound) for the purpose of comparing the
5785 /// cv-decomposition of two types per C++ [conv.qual].
5786 void ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
5787   while (true) {
5788     auto *AT1 = getAsArrayType(T1);
5789     if (!AT1)
5790       return;
5791 
5792     auto *AT2 = getAsArrayType(T2);
5793     if (!AT2)
5794       return;
5795 
5796     // If we don't have two array types with the same constant bound nor two
5797     // incomplete array types, we've unwrapped everything we can.
5798     if (auto *CAT1 = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT1)) {
5799       auto *CAT2 = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT2);
5800       if (!CAT2 || CAT1->getSize() != CAT2->getSize())
5801         return;
5802     } else if (!isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT1) ||
5803                !isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT2)) {
5804       return;
5805     }
5806 
5807     T1 = AT1->getElementType();
5808     T2 = AT2->getElementType();
5809   }
5810 }
5811 
5812 /// Attempt to unwrap two types that may be similar (C++ [conv.qual]).
5813 ///
5814 /// If T1 and T2 are both pointer types of the same kind, or both array types
5815 /// with the same bound, unwraps layers from T1 and T2 until a pointer type is
5816 /// unwrapped. Top-level qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored.
5817 ///
5818 /// This function will typically be called in a loop that successively
5819 /// "unwraps" pointer and pointer-to-member types to compare them at each
5820 /// level.
5821 ///
5822 /// \return \c true if a pointer type was unwrapped, \c false if we reached a
5823 /// pair of types that can't be unwrapped further.
5824 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
5825   UnwrapSimilarArrayTypes(T1, T2);
5826 
5827   const auto *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>();
5828   const auto *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
5829   if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
5830     T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
5831     T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
5832     return true;
5833   }
5834 
5835   const auto *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
5836   const auto *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
5837   if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
5838       hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
5839                              QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
5840     T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
5841     T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
5842     return true;
5843   }
5844 
5845   if (getLangOpts().ObjC) {
5846     const auto *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5847     const auto *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5848     if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
5849       T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
5850       T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
5851       return true;
5852     }
5853   }
5854 
5855   // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
5856 
5857   return false;
5858 }
5859 
5860 bool ASTContext::hasSimilarType(QualType T1, QualType T2) {
5861   while (true) {
5862     Qualifiers Quals;
5863     T1 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
5864     T2 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
5865     if (hasSameType(T1, T2))
5866       return true;
5867     if (!UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2))
5868       return false;
5869   }
5870 }
5871 
5872 bool ASTContext::hasCvrSimilarType(QualType T1, QualType T2) {
5873   while (true) {
5874     Qualifiers Quals1, Quals2;
5875     T1 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals1);
5876     T2 = getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals2);
5877 
5878     Quals1.removeCVRQualifiers();
5879     Quals2.removeCVRQualifiers();
5880     if (Quals1 != Quals2)
5881       return false;
5882 
5883     if (hasSameType(T1, T2))
5884       return true;
5885 
5886     if (!UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2))
5887       return false;
5888   }
5889 }
5890 
5891 DeclarationNameInfo
5892 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
5893                                SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
5894   switch (Name.getKind()) {
5895   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
5896   case TemplateName::Template:
5897     // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
5898     return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
5899                                NameLoc);
5900 
5901   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
5902     OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
5903     // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
5904     return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
5905   }
5906 
5907   case TemplateName::AssumedTemplate: {
5908     AssumedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsAssumedTemplateName();
5909     return DeclarationNameInfo(Storage->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
5910   }
5911 
5912   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
5913     DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
5914     DeclarationName DName;
5915     if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
5916       DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
5917       return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
5918     } else {
5919       DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
5920       // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
5921       DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc =
5922           DeclarationNameLoc::makeCXXOperatorNameLoc(SourceRange());
5923       return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
5924     }
5925   }
5926 
5927   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
5928     SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
5929       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
5930     return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
5931                                NameLoc);
5932   }
5933 
5934   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
5935     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
5936       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
5937     return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
5938                                NameLoc);
5939   }
5940   }
5941 
5942   llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
5943 }
5944 
5945 TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
5946   switch (Name.getKind()) {
5947   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
5948   case TemplateName::Template: {
5949     TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
5950     if (auto *TTP  = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
5951       Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
5952 
5953     // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
5954     return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
5955   }
5956 
5957   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
5958   case TemplateName::AssumedTemplate:
5959     llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize unresolved template");
5960 
5961   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
5962     DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
5963     assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
5964     return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
5965   }
5966 
5967   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
5968     SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
5969       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
5970     return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
5971   }
5972 
5973   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
5974     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
5975                                   = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
5976     TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
5977       = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
5978     TemplateArgument canonArgPack
5979       = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
5980     return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
5981   }
5982   }
5983 
5984   llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
5985 }
5986 
5987 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
5988   X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
5989   Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
5990   return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
5991 }
5992 
5993 TemplateArgument
5994 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
5995   switch (Arg.getKind()) {
5996     case TemplateArgument::Null:
5997       return Arg;
5998 
5999     case TemplateArgument::Expression:
6000       return Arg;
6001 
6002     case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
6003       auto *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
6004       return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
6005     }
6006 
6007     case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
6008       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
6009                               /*isNullPtr*/true);
6010 
6011     case TemplateArgument::Template:
6012       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
6013 
6014     case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
6015       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
6016                                          Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
6017                               Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
6018 
6019     case TemplateArgument::Integral:
6020       return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
6021 
6022     case TemplateArgument::Type:
6023       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
6024 
6025     case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
6026       if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
6027         return Arg;
6028 
6029       auto *CanonArgs = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
6030       unsigned Idx = 0;
6031       for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
6032                                         AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
6033            A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
6034         CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
6035 
6036       return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
6037     }
6038   }
6039 
6040   // Silence GCC warning
6041   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
6042 }
6043 
6044 NestedNameSpecifier *
6045 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
6046   if (!NNS)
6047     return nullptr;
6048 
6049   switch (NNS->getKind()) {
6050   case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
6051     // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
6052     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
6053                          getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
6054                                        NNS->getAsIdentifier());
6055 
6056   case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
6057     // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
6058     // this namespace and no prefix.
6059     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
6060                                  NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
6061 
6062   case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
6063     // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
6064     // this namespace and no prefix.
6065     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
6066                                     NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
6067                                                       ->getOriginalNamespace());
6068 
6069   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
6070   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
6071     QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
6072 
6073     // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
6074     // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
6075     // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
6076     // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
6077     // types, e.g.,
6078     //   typedef typename T::type T1;
6079     //   typedef typename T1::type T2;
6080     if (const auto *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
6081       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
6082                            const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
6083 
6084     // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
6085     // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
6086     // first place?
6087     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
6088                                        const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
6089   }
6090 
6091   case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
6092   case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
6093     // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
6094     return NNS;
6095   }
6096 
6097   llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
6098 }
6099 
6100 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
6101   // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
6102   if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
6103     // Handle the common positive case fast.
6104     if (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
6105       return AT;
6106   }
6107 
6108   // Handle the common negative case fast.
6109   if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
6110     return nullptr;
6111 
6112   // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type.  This
6113   // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
6114   // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
6115 
6116   // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
6117   // sugar such as a typedef in the way.  If we have type qualifiers on the type
6118   // we must propagate them down into the element type.
6119 
6120   SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
6121   Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
6122 
6123   // If we have a simple case, just return now.
6124   const auto *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
6125   if (!ATy || qs.empty())
6126     return ATy;
6127 
6128   // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it.  Push the
6129   // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
6130   QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
6131 
6132   if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
6133     return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
6134                                                 CAT->getSizeExpr(),
6135                                                 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
6136                                            CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
6137   if (const auto *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
6138     return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
6139                                                   IAT->getSizeModifier(),
6140                                            IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
6141 
6142   if (const auto *DSAT = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
6143     return cast<ArrayType>(
6144                      getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
6145                                                 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
6146                                                 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
6147                                               DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
6148                                                 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
6149 
6150   const auto *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
6151   return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
6152                                               VAT->getSizeExpr(),
6153                                               VAT->getSizeModifier(),
6154                                               VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
6155                                               VAT->getBracketsRange()));
6156 }
6157 
6158 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
6159   if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
6160     return getDecayedType(T);
6161   return T;
6162 }
6163 
6164 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
6165   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
6166   T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
6167   return T.getUnqualifiedType();
6168 }
6169 
6170 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
6171   // C++ [except.throw]p3:
6172   //   A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
6173   //   object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
6174   //   cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
6175   //   the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
6176   //   or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
6177   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
6178   if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
6179     T = getDecayedType(T);
6180   return T.getUnqualifiedType();
6181 }
6182 
6183 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
6184 /// specified array type to a pointer.  This operation is non-trivial when
6185 /// handling typedefs etc.  The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
6186 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
6187 ///
6188 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
6189 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
6190   // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
6191   // typedefs in the element type of the array.  This also handles propagation
6192   // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
6193   // (C99 6.7.3p8).
6194   const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
6195   assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
6196 
6197   QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
6198 
6199   // int x[restrict 4] ->  int *restrict
6200   QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy,
6201                                      PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
6202 
6203   // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable
6204   if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability(*this)) {
6205     Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType(
6206         AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result);
6207   }
6208   return Result;
6209 }
6210 
6211 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
6212   return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
6213 }
6214 
6215 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
6216   Qualifiers qs;
6217   while (true) {
6218     SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
6219     const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
6220     if (!array) break;
6221 
6222     type = array->getElementType();
6223     qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
6224   }
6225 
6226   return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
6227 }
6228 
6229 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
6230 uint64_t
6231 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA)  const {
6232   uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
6233   do {
6234     ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
6235     CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
6236       CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
6237   } while (CA);
6238   return ElementCount;
6239 }
6240 
6241 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
6242 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
6243 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
6244   if (const auto *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
6245     return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
6246 
6247   switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
6248   default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
6249   case BuiltinType::Float16:    return Float16Rank;
6250   case BuiltinType::Half:       return HalfRank;
6251   case BuiltinType::Float:      return FloatRank;
6252   case BuiltinType::Double:     return DoubleRank;
6253   case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
6254   case BuiltinType::Float128:   return Float128Rank;
6255   case BuiltinType::BFloat16:   return BFloat16Rank;
6256   }
6257 }
6258 
6259 /// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
6260 /// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
6261 /// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
6262 /// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
6263 QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
6264                                                        QualType Domain) const {
6265   FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
6266   if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
6267     switch (EltRank) {
6268     case BFloat16Rank: llvm_unreachable("Complex bfloat16 is not supported");
6269     case Float16Rank:
6270     case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
6271     case FloatRank:      return FloatComplexTy;
6272     case DoubleRank:     return DoubleComplexTy;
6273     case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
6274     case Float128Rank:   return Float128ComplexTy;
6275     }
6276   }
6277 
6278   assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
6279   switch (EltRank) {
6280   case Float16Rank:    return HalfTy;
6281   case BFloat16Rank:   return BFloat16Ty;
6282   case HalfRank:       return HalfTy;
6283   case FloatRank:      return FloatTy;
6284   case DoubleRank:     return DoubleTy;
6285   case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
6286   case Float128Rank:   return Float128Ty;
6287   }
6288   llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
6289 }
6290 
6291 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
6292 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
6293 /// '_Complex double').  If LHS > RHS, return 1.  If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
6294 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
6295 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
6296   FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
6297   FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
6298 
6299   if (LHSR == RHSR)
6300     return 0;
6301   if (LHSR > RHSR)
6302     return 1;
6303   return -1;
6304 }
6305 
6306 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeSemanticOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
6307   if (&getFloatTypeSemantics(LHS) == &getFloatTypeSemantics(RHS))
6308     return 0;
6309   return getFloatingTypeOrder(LHS, RHS);
6310 }
6311 
6312 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
6313 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
6314 /// or if it is not canonicalized.
6315 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
6316   assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
6317 
6318   // Results in this 'losing' to any type of the same size, but winning if
6319   // larger.
6320   if (const auto *EIT = dyn_cast<ExtIntType>(T))
6321     return 0 + (EIT->getNumBits() << 3);
6322 
6323   switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
6324   default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
6325   case BuiltinType::Bool:
6326     return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
6327   case BuiltinType::Char_S:
6328   case BuiltinType::Char_U:
6329   case BuiltinType::SChar:
6330   case BuiltinType::UChar:
6331     return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
6332   case BuiltinType::Short:
6333   case BuiltinType::UShort:
6334     return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
6335   case BuiltinType::Int:
6336   case BuiltinType::UInt:
6337     return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
6338   case BuiltinType::Long:
6339   case BuiltinType::ULong:
6340     return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
6341   case BuiltinType::LongLong:
6342   case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
6343     return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
6344   case BuiltinType::Int128:
6345   case BuiltinType::UInt128:
6346     return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
6347   }
6348 }
6349 
6350 /// Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
6351 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
6352 ///
6353 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
6354 /// promotion occurs.
6355 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
6356   if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
6357     return {};
6358 
6359   // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
6360   //    If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other
6361   //    value of that type for promotion purposes.
6362   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->getType()->isEnumeralType())
6363     return {};
6364 
6365   // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
6366   // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
6367   // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
6368 
6369   FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
6370   if (!Field)
6371     return {};
6372 
6373   QualType FT = Field->getType();
6374 
6375   uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
6376   uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
6377   // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
6378   //   A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
6379   //   int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
6380   //   can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
6381   //   values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
6382   //   promotion applies to it.
6383   // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
6384   //   [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
6385   //   If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
6386   //   the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
6387   //   it is converted to an unsigned int.
6388   //
6389   // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
6390   //        We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
6391   // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of an enum bit-field whose rank is
6392   //        greater than that of 'int'. We perform that promotion to match GCC.
6393   if (BitWidth < IntSize)
6394     return IntTy;
6395 
6396   if (BitWidth == IntSize)
6397     return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
6398 
6399   // Bit-fields wider than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
6400   // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
6401   // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
6402   // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
6403   // into their semantics in some cases).
6404   return {};
6405 }
6406 
6407 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
6408 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
6409 /// integer type.
6410 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
6411   assert(!Promotable.isNull());
6412   assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
6413   if (const auto *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
6414     return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
6415 
6416   if (const auto *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
6417     // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
6418     // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
6419     // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
6420     // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
6421     // unsigned long long int [...]
6422     // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
6423     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
6424         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
6425         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char8 ||
6426         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
6427         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
6428       bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
6429       uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
6430       QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
6431                                   LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
6432       for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
6433         uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
6434         if (FromSize < ToSize ||
6435             (FromSize == ToSize &&
6436              FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
6437           return PromoteTypes[Idx];
6438       }
6439       llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
6440     }
6441   }
6442 
6443   // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
6444   if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
6445     return IntTy;
6446   uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
6447   uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
6448   assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
6449   return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
6450 }
6451 
6452 /// Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
6453 /// type and returns its ownership.
6454 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
6455   while (!T.isNull()) {
6456     if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
6457       return T.getObjCLifetime();
6458     if (T->isArrayType())
6459       T = getBaseElementType(T);
6460     else if (const auto *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
6461       T = PT->getPointeeType();
6462     else if (const auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6463       T = RT->getPointeeType();
6464     else
6465       break;
6466   }
6467 
6468   return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
6469 }
6470 
6471 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
6472   // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
6473   // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
6474   if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
6475     return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
6476   return nullptr;
6477 }
6478 
6479 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
6480 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1.  If LHS > RHS, return 1.  If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
6481 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
6482 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
6483   const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
6484   const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
6485 
6486   // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
6487   if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
6488     LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
6489   if (const auto *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
6490     RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
6491 
6492   if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
6493 
6494   bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
6495   bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
6496 
6497   unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
6498   unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
6499 
6500   if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) {  // Both signed or both unsigned.
6501     if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
6502     return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
6503   }
6504 
6505   // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
6506   if (LHSUnsigned) {
6507     // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
6508     if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
6509       return 1;
6510 
6511     // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
6512     // wins.  Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
6513     // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
6514     return -1;
6515   }
6516 
6517   // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
6518   if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
6519     return -1;
6520 
6521   // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
6522   // wins.  Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
6523   // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
6524   return 1;
6525 }
6526 
6527 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
6528   if (CFConstantStringTypeDecl)
6529     return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
6530 
6531   assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
6532          "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
6533   CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
6534   CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
6535 
6536   struct {
6537     QualType Type;
6538     const char *Name;
6539   } Fields[5];
6540   unsigned Count = 0;
6541 
6542   /// Objective-C ABI
6543   ///
6544   ///    typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag {
6545   ///      const int *isa;
6546   ///      int flags;
6547   ///      const char *str;
6548   ///      long length;
6549   ///    } __NSConstantString;
6550   ///
6551   /// Swift ABI (4.1, 4.2)
6552   ///
6553   ///    typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag {
6554   ///      uintptr_t _cfisa;
6555   ///      uintptr_t _swift_rc;
6556   ///      _Atomic(uint64_t) _cfinfoa;
6557   ///      const char *_ptr;
6558   ///      uint32_t _length;
6559   ///    } __NSConstantString;
6560   ///
6561   /// Swift ABI (5.0)
6562   ///
6563   ///    typedef struct __NSConstantString_tag {
6564   ///      uintptr_t _cfisa;
6565   ///      uintptr_t _swift_rc;
6566   ///      _Atomic(uint64_t) _cfinfoa;
6567   ///      const char *_ptr;
6568   ///      uintptr_t _length;
6569   ///    } __NSConstantString;
6570 
6571   const auto CFRuntime = getLangOpts().CFRuntime;
6572   if (static_cast<unsigned>(CFRuntime) <
6573       static_cast<unsigned>(LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift)) {
6574     Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(IntTy.withConst()), "isa" };
6575     Fields[Count++] = { IntTy, "flags" };
6576     Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()), "str" };
6577     Fields[Count++] = { LongTy, "length" };
6578   } else {
6579     Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_cfisa" };
6580     Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_swift_rc" };
6581     Fields[Count++] = { getFromTargetType(Target->getUInt64Type()), "_swift_rc" };
6582     Fields[Count++] = { getPointerType(CharTy.withConst()), "_ptr" };
6583     if (CFRuntime == LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift4_1 ||
6584         CFRuntime == LangOptions::CoreFoundationABI::Swift4_2)
6585       Fields[Count++] = { IntTy, "_ptr" };
6586     else
6587       Fields[Count++] = { getUIntPtrType(), "_ptr" };
6588   }
6589 
6590   // Create fields
6591   for (unsigned i = 0; i < Count; ++i) {
6592     FieldDecl *Field =
6593         FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl, SourceLocation(),
6594                           SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Fields[i].Name),
6595                           Fields[i].Type, /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6596                           /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
6597     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6598     CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6599   }
6600 
6601   CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6602   // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
6603   // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
6604   auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
6605   CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
6606       buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
6607 
6608   return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
6609 }
6610 
6611 RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
6612   if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
6613     getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
6614   return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
6615 }
6616 
6617 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
6618 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
6619   return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
6620 }
6621 
6622 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
6623   if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
6624     RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
6625     TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
6626     ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
6627   }
6628   return ObjCSuperType;
6629 }
6630 
6631 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
6632   const auto *TD = T->castAs<TypedefType>();
6633   CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
6634   const auto *TagType =
6635       CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->castAs<RecordType>();
6636   CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
6637 }
6638 
6639 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
6640   if (BlockDescriptorType)
6641     return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
6642 
6643   RecordDecl *RD;
6644   // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
6645   RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
6646   RD->startDefinition();
6647 
6648   QualType FieldTypes[] = {
6649     UnsignedLongTy,
6650     UnsignedLongTy,
6651   };
6652 
6653   static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
6654     "reserved",
6655     "Size"
6656   };
6657 
6658   for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
6659     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
6660         *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6661         &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6662         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
6663     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6664     RD->addDecl(Field);
6665   }
6666 
6667   RD->completeDefinition();
6668 
6669   BlockDescriptorType = RD;
6670 
6671   return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
6672 }
6673 
6674 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
6675   if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
6676     return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
6677 
6678   RecordDecl *RD;
6679   // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
6680   RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
6681   RD->startDefinition();
6682 
6683   QualType FieldTypes[] = {
6684     UnsignedLongTy,
6685     UnsignedLongTy,
6686     getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
6687     getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
6688   };
6689 
6690   static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
6691     "reserved",
6692     "Size",
6693     "CopyFuncPtr",
6694     "DestroyFuncPtr"
6695   };
6696 
6697   for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
6698     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
6699         *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6700         &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6701         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6702         /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
6703     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6704     RD->addDecl(Field);
6705   }
6706 
6707   RD->completeDefinition();
6708 
6709   BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
6710   return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
6711 }
6712 
6713 OpenCLTypeKind ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type *T) const {
6714   const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(T);
6715 
6716   if (!BT) {
6717     if (isa<PipeType>(T))
6718       return OCLTK_Pipe;
6719 
6720     return OCLTK_Default;
6721   }
6722 
6723   switch (BT->getKind()) {
6724 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix)                   \
6725   case BuiltinType::Id:                                                        \
6726     return OCLTK_Image;
6727 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
6728 
6729   case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
6730     return OCLTK_ClkEvent;
6731 
6732   case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
6733     return OCLTK_Event;
6734 
6735   case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
6736     return OCLTK_Queue;
6737 
6738   case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
6739     return OCLTK_ReserveID;
6740 
6741   case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
6742     return OCLTK_Sampler;
6743 
6744   default:
6745     return OCLTK_Default;
6746   }
6747 }
6748 
6749 LangAS ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type *T) const {
6750   return Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T));
6751 }
6752 
6753 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
6754 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
6755 /// in buildByrefHelpers.
6756 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
6757                                       const VarDecl *D) {
6758   if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
6759     const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInit(D).getCopyExpr();
6760     if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
6761 
6762     return true;
6763   }
6764 
6765   // The block needs copy/destroy helpers if Ty is non-trivial to destructively
6766   // move or destroy.
6767   if (Ty.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructiveMove() || Ty.isDestructedType())
6768     return true;
6769 
6770   if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
6771 
6772   Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
6773 
6774   // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
6775   if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
6776     switch (lifetime) {
6777       case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
6778 
6779       // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
6780       case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
6781       case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
6782         return false;
6783 
6784       // These cases should have been taken care of when checking the type's
6785       // non-triviality.
6786       case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
6787       case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
6788         llvm_unreachable("impossible");
6789     }
6790     llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
6791   }
6792   return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
6793           Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
6794 }
6795 
6796 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
6797                               Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
6798                               bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
6799   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC ||
6800       getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
6801     return false;
6802 
6803   HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
6804   if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
6805     HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
6806     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
6807   } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
6808     // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
6809   } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
6810     // The MRR rule.
6811     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
6812   } else {
6813     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
6814   }
6815   return true;
6816 }
6817 
6818 CanQualType ASTContext::getNSUIntegerType() const {
6819   assert(Target && "Expected target to be initialized");
6820   const llvm::Triple &T = Target->getTriple();
6821   // Windows is LLP64 rather than LP64
6822   if (T.isOSWindows() && T.isArch64Bit())
6823     return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6824   return UnsignedLongTy;
6825 }
6826 
6827 CanQualType ASTContext::getNSIntegerType() const {
6828   assert(Target && "Expected target to be initialized");
6829   const llvm::Triple &T = Target->getTriple();
6830   // Windows is LLP64 rather than LP64
6831   if (T.isOSWindows() && T.isArch64Bit())
6832     return LongLongTy;
6833   return LongTy;
6834 }
6835 
6836 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
6837   if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
6838     ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
6839         buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
6840   return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
6841 }
6842 
6843 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
6844 // typedef <type> BOOL;
6845 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
6846   if (const auto *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
6847     if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
6848       return II->isStr("BOOL");
6849 
6850   return false;
6851 }
6852 
6853 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
6854 /// purpose.
6855 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
6856   if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
6857     return CharUnits::Zero();
6858 
6859   CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
6860 
6861   // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
6862   if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
6863     sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
6864   // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
6865   else if (type->isArrayType())
6866     sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
6867   return sz;
6868 }
6869 
6870 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
6871   return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
6872          VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
6873          VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
6874          !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
6875 }
6876 
6877 ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
6878 ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
6879   if (!VD->isInline())
6880     return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
6881 
6882   // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
6883   auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
6884   if (First->isInlineSpecified() || !First->isStaticDataMember())
6885     return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
6886 
6887   // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
6888   // non-discardable definition.
6889   for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
6890     if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
6891         !D->isInlineSpecified() && (D->isConstexpr() || First->isConstexpr()))
6892       return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
6893 
6894   // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
6895   return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
6896 }
6897 
6898 static std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
6899   return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
6900 }
6901 
6902 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
6903 /// declaration.
6904 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
6905   std::string S;
6906 
6907   const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
6908   QualType BlockTy =
6909       Expr->getType()->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6910   QualType BlockReturnTy = BlockTy->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType();
6911   // Encode result type.
6912   if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
6913     getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockReturnTy, S,
6914                                       true /*Extended*/);
6915   else
6916     getObjCEncodingForType(BlockReturnTy, S);
6917   // Compute size of all parameters.
6918   // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
6919   // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
6920   CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
6921   CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
6922   for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
6923     QualType PType = PI->getType();
6924     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
6925     if (sz.isZero())
6926       continue;
6927     assert(sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
6928     ParmOffset += sz;
6929   }
6930   // Size of the argument frame
6931   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
6932   // Block pointer and offset.
6933   S += "@?0";
6934 
6935   // Argument types.
6936   ParmOffset = PtrSize;
6937   for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
6938     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
6939     if (const auto *AT =
6940             dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
6941       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
6942       // elements.
6943       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6944         PType = PVDecl->getType();
6945     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
6946       PType = PVDecl->getType();
6947     if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
6948       getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
6949                                       S, true /*Extended*/);
6950     else
6951       getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
6952     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
6953     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
6954   }
6955 
6956   return S;
6957 }
6958 
6959 std::string
6960 ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const {
6961   std::string S;
6962   // Encode result type.
6963   getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
6964   CharUnits ParmOffset;
6965   // Compute size of all parameters.
6966   for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
6967     QualType PType = PI->getType();
6968     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
6969     if (sz.isZero())
6970       continue;
6971 
6972     assert(sz.isPositive() &&
6973            "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
6974     ParmOffset += sz;
6975   }
6976   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
6977   ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
6978 
6979   // Argument types.
6980   for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
6981     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
6982     if (const auto *AT =
6983             dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
6984       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
6985       // elements.
6986       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6987         PType = PVDecl->getType();
6988     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
6989       PType = PVDecl->getType();
6990     getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
6991     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
6992     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
6993   }
6994 
6995   return S;
6996 }
6997 
6998 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
6999 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
7000 /// block object types.
7001 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
7002                                                    QualType T, std::string& S,
7003                                                    bool Extended) const {
7004   // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
7005   getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
7006   // Encode parameter type.
7007   ObjCEncOptions Options = ObjCEncOptions()
7008                                .setExpandPointedToStructures()
7009                                .setExpandStructures()
7010                                .setIsOutermostType();
7011   if (Extended)
7012     Options.setEncodeBlockParameters().setEncodeClassNames();
7013   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, Options, /*Field=*/nullptr);
7014 }
7015 
7016 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
7017 /// declaration.
7018 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
7019                                                      bool Extended) const {
7020   // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
7021   // Encode return type.
7022   std::string S;
7023   getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
7024                                     Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
7025   // Compute size of all parameters.
7026   // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
7027   // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
7028   CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
7029   // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
7030   // their size.
7031   CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
7032   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
7033        E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
7034     QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
7035     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
7036     if (sz.isZero())
7037       continue;
7038 
7039     assert(sz.isPositive() &&
7040            "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
7041     ParmOffset += sz;
7042   }
7043   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
7044   S += "@0:";
7045   S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
7046 
7047   // Argument types.
7048   ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
7049   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
7050        E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
7051     const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
7052     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
7053     if (const auto *AT =
7054             dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
7055       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
7056       // elements.
7057       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
7058         PType = PVDecl->getType();
7059     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
7060       PType = PVDecl->getType();
7061     getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
7062                                       PType, S, Extended);
7063     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
7064     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
7065   }
7066 
7067   return S;
7068 }
7069 
7070 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
7071 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
7072                                       const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
7073                                       const Decl *Container) const {
7074   if (!Container)
7075     return nullptr;
7076   if (const auto *CID = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
7077     for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
7078       if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
7079         return PID;
7080   } else {
7081     const auto *OID = cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
7082     for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
7083       if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
7084         return PID;
7085   }
7086   return nullptr;
7087 }
7088 
7089 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
7090 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
7091 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
7092 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
7093 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
7094 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
7095 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
7096 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
7097 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
7098 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
7099 /// @code
7100 /// enum PropertyAttributes {
7101 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R',   // property is read-only.
7102 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C',     // property is a copy of the value last assigned
7103 /// kPropertyByref = '&',  // property is a reference to the value last assigned
7104 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D',    // property is dynamic
7105 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G',     // followed by getter selector name
7106 /// kPropertySetter = 'S',     // followed by setter selector name
7107 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V'  // followed by instance variable  name
7108 /// kPropertyType = 'T'              // followed by old-style type encoding.
7109 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W'              // 'weak' property
7110 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P'            // property GC'able
7111 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N'         // property non-atomic
7112 /// };
7113 /// @endcode
7114 std::string
7115 ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
7116                                            const Decl *Container) const {
7117   // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
7118   bool Dynamic = false;
7119   ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
7120 
7121   if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
7122       getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
7123     if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
7124       Dynamic = true;
7125     else
7126       SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
7127   }
7128 
7129   // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
7130   std::string S = "T";
7131 
7132   // Encode result type.
7133   // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
7134   // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
7135   getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
7136 
7137   if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
7138     S += ",R";
7139     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_copy)
7140       S += ",C";
7141     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_retain)
7142       S += ",&";
7143     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_weak)
7144       S += ",W";
7145   } else {
7146     switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
7147     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
7148     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy:   S += ",C"; break;
7149     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
7150     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak:   S += ",W"; break;
7151     }
7152   }
7153 
7154   // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
7155   // are "dynamic by default".
7156   if (Dynamic)
7157     S += ",D";
7158 
7159   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_nonatomic)
7160     S += ",N";
7161 
7162   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_getter) {
7163     S += ",G";
7164     S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
7165   }
7166 
7167   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyAttribute::kind_setter) {
7168     S += ",S";
7169     S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
7170   }
7171 
7172   if (SynthesizePID) {
7173     const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
7174     S += ",V";
7175     S += OID->getNameAsString();
7176   }
7177 
7178   // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
7179   return S;
7180 }
7181 
7182 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
7183 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
7184 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always.  For typedefs, we need to use
7185 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
7186 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
7187   if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
7188     if (const auto *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
7189       if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
7190         PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
7191       else
7192         if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
7193           PointeeTy = IntTy;
7194     }
7195   }
7196 }
7197 
7198 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
7199                                         const FieldDecl *Field,
7200                                         QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
7201   // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
7202   // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
7203   // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
7204   // same type.
7205   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S,
7206                              ObjCEncOptions()
7207                                  .setExpandPointedToStructures()
7208                                  .setExpandStructures()
7209                                  .setIsOutermostType(),
7210                              Field, NotEncodedT);
7211 }
7212 
7213 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
7214                                                 std::string& S) const {
7215   // Encode result type.
7216   // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
7217   // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
7218   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S,
7219                              ObjCEncOptions()
7220                                  .setExpandPointedToStructures()
7221                                  .setExpandStructures()
7222                                  .setIsOutermostType()
7223                                  .setEncodingProperty(),
7224                              /*Field=*/nullptr);
7225 }
7226 
7227 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(const ASTContext *C,
7228                                             const BuiltinType *BT) {
7229     BuiltinType::Kind kind = BT->getKind();
7230     switch (kind) {
7231     case BuiltinType::Void:       return 'v';
7232     case BuiltinType::Bool:       return 'B';
7233     case BuiltinType::Char8:
7234     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
7235     case BuiltinType::UChar:      return 'C';
7236     case BuiltinType::Char16:
7237     case BuiltinType::UShort:     return 'S';
7238     case BuiltinType::Char32:
7239     case BuiltinType::UInt:       return 'I';
7240     case BuiltinType::ULong:
7241         return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
7242     case BuiltinType::UInt128:    return 'T';
7243     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:  return 'Q';
7244     case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7245     case BuiltinType::SChar:      return 'c';
7246     case BuiltinType::Short:      return 's';
7247     case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
7248     case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
7249     case BuiltinType::Int:        return 'i';
7250     case BuiltinType::Long:
7251       return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
7252     case BuiltinType::LongLong:   return 'q';
7253     case BuiltinType::Int128:     return 't';
7254     case BuiltinType::Float:      return 'f';
7255     case BuiltinType::Double:     return 'd';
7256     case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
7257     case BuiltinType::NullPtr:    return '*'; // like char*
7258 
7259     case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
7260     case BuiltinType::Float16:
7261     case BuiltinType::Float128:
7262     case BuiltinType::Half:
7263     case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
7264     case BuiltinType::Accum:
7265     case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
7266     case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
7267     case BuiltinType::UAccum:
7268     case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
7269     case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
7270     case BuiltinType::Fract:
7271     case BuiltinType::LongFract:
7272     case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
7273     case BuiltinType::UFract:
7274     case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
7275     case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
7276     case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
7277     case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
7278     case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
7279     case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
7280     case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
7281     case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
7282     case BuiltinType::SatFract:
7283     case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
7284     case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
7285     case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
7286     case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
7287       // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
7288       return ' ';
7289 
7290 #define SVE_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) \
7291     case BuiltinType::Id:
7292 #include "clang/Basic/AArch64SVEACLETypes.def"
7293 #define RVV_TYPE(Name, Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id:
7294 #include "clang/Basic/RISCVVTypes.def"
7295       {
7296         DiagnosticsEngine &Diags = C->getDiagnostics();
7297         unsigned DiagID = Diags.getCustomDiagID(DiagnosticsEngine::Error,
7298                                                 "cannot yet @encode type %0");
7299         Diags.Report(DiagID) << BT->getName(C->getPrintingPolicy());
7300         return ' ';
7301       }
7302 
7303     case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
7304     case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
7305     case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
7306       llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
7307 
7308     // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
7309 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
7310     case BuiltinType::Id:
7311 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
7312 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \
7313     case BuiltinType::Id:
7314 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def"
7315     case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
7316     case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
7317     case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
7318     case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
7319     case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
7320     case BuiltinType::Dependent:
7321 #define PPC_VECTOR_TYPE(Name, Id, Size) \
7322     case BuiltinType::Id:
7323 #include "clang/Basic/PPCTypes.def"
7324 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
7325 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
7326     case BuiltinType::KIND:
7327 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
7328       llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
7329     }
7330     llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
7331 }
7332 
7333 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
7334   EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
7335 
7336   // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
7337   if (!Enum->isFixed())
7338     return 'i';
7339 
7340   // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
7341   const auto *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
7342   return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(C, BT);
7343 }
7344 
7345 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
7346                            QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
7347   assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
7348   S += 'b';
7349   // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
7350   // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
7351   // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
7352   // bitfield, then the size in bits.  For example, in this structure:
7353   //
7354   // struct
7355   // {
7356   //    int integer;
7357   //    int flags:2;
7358   // };
7359   // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
7360   // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime.  The reason for this extra
7361   // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
7362   // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
7363   // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
7364   if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
7365     uint64_t Offset;
7366 
7367     if (const auto *IVD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(FD)) {
7368       Offset = Ctx->lookupFieldBitOffset(IVD->getContainingInterface(), nullptr,
7369                                          IVD);
7370     } else {
7371       const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
7372       const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
7373       Offset = RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex());
7374     }
7375 
7376     S += llvm::utostr(Offset);
7377 
7378     if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7379       S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
7380     else {
7381       const auto *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
7382       S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(Ctx, BT);
7383     }
7384   }
7385   S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
7386 }
7387 
7388 // Helper function for determining whether the encoded type string would include
7389 // a template specialization type.
7390 static bool hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(const Type *T,
7391                                                      bool VisitBasesAndFields) {
7392   T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
7393 
7394   if (auto *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
7395     return hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(
7396         PT->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(), false);
7397 
7398   auto *CXXRD = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
7399 
7400   if (!CXXRD)
7401     return false;
7402 
7403   if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CXXRD))
7404     return true;
7405 
7406   if (!CXXRD->hasDefinition() || !VisitBasesAndFields)
7407     return false;
7408 
7409   for (auto B : CXXRD->bases())
7410     if (hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(B.getType().getTypePtr(),
7411                                                  true))
7412       return true;
7413 
7414   for (auto *FD : CXXRD->fields())
7415     if (hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(FD->getType().getTypePtr(),
7416                                                  true))
7417       return true;
7418 
7419   return false;
7420 }
7421 
7422 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
7423 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string &S,
7424                                             const ObjCEncOptions Options,
7425                                             const FieldDecl *FD,
7426                                             QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
7427   CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
7428   switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
7429   case Type::Builtin:
7430   case Type::Enum:
7431     if (FD && FD->isBitField())
7432       return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
7433     if (const auto *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
7434       S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveType(this, BT);
7435     else
7436       S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
7437     return;
7438 
7439   case Type::Complex:
7440     S += 'j';
7441     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), S,
7442                                ObjCEncOptions(),
7443                                /*Field=*/nullptr);
7444     return;
7445 
7446   case Type::Atomic:
7447     S += 'A';
7448     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T->castAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType(), S,
7449                                ObjCEncOptions(),
7450                                /*Field=*/nullptr);
7451     return;
7452 
7453   // encoding for pointer or reference types.
7454   case Type::Pointer:
7455   case Type::LValueReference:
7456   case Type::RValueReference: {
7457     QualType PointeeTy;
7458     if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
7459       const auto *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
7460       if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
7461         S += ':';
7462         return;
7463       }
7464       PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
7465     } else {
7466       PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
7467     }
7468 
7469     bool isReadOnly = false;
7470     // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
7471     // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'.  The read-only qualifier of
7472     // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
7473     // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
7474     if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
7475       if (Options.IsOutermostType() && T.isConstQualified()) {
7476         isReadOnly = true;
7477         S += 'r';
7478       }
7479     } else if (Options.IsOutermostType()) {
7480       QualType P = PointeeTy;
7481       while (auto PT = P->getAs<PointerType>())
7482         P = PT->getPointeeType();
7483       if (P.isConstQualified()) {
7484         isReadOnly = true;
7485         S += 'r';
7486       }
7487     }
7488     if (isReadOnly) {
7489       // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
7490       // combinations need to be rearranged.
7491       // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
7492       if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
7493         S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
7494     }
7495 
7496     if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
7497       // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
7498       // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
7499       if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
7500         S += '*';
7501         return;
7502       }
7503     } else if (const auto *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7504       // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
7505       if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
7506         S += '#';
7507         return;
7508       }
7509       // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
7510       if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
7511         S += '@';
7512         return;
7513       }
7514       // If the encoded string for the class includes template names, just emit
7515       // "^v" for pointers to the class.
7516       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
7517           (!getLangOpts().EncodeCXXClassTemplateSpec &&
7518            hasTemplateSpecializationInEncodedString(
7519                RTy, Options.ExpandPointedToStructures()))) {
7520         S += "^v";
7521         return;
7522       }
7523       // fall through...
7524     }
7525     S += '^';
7526     getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
7527 
7528     ObjCEncOptions NewOptions;
7529     if (Options.ExpandPointedToStructures())
7530       NewOptions.setExpandStructures();
7531     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, NewOptions,
7532                                /*Field=*/nullptr, NotEncodedT);
7533     return;
7534   }
7535 
7536   case Type::ConstantArray:
7537   case Type::IncompleteArray:
7538   case Type::VariableArray: {
7539     const auto *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
7540 
7541     if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !Options.IsStructField()) {
7542       // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
7543       S += '^';
7544 
7545       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
7546           AT->getElementType(), S,
7547           Options.keepingOnly(ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures()), FD);
7548     } else {
7549       S += '[';
7550 
7551       if (const auto *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
7552         S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
7553       else {
7554         //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
7555         assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
7556                "Unknown array type!");
7557         S += '0';
7558       }
7559 
7560       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
7561           AT->getElementType(), S,
7562           Options.keepingOnly(ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures()), FD,
7563           NotEncodedT);
7564       S += ']';
7565     }
7566     return;
7567   }
7568 
7569   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
7570   case Type::FunctionProto:
7571     S += '?';
7572     return;
7573 
7574   case Type::Record: {
7575     RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
7576     S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
7577     // Anonymous structures print as '?'
7578     if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
7579       S += II->getName();
7580       if (const auto *Spec = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
7581         const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7582         llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
7583         printTemplateArgumentList(OS, TemplateArgs.asArray(),
7584                                   getPrintingPolicy());
7585       }
7586     } else {
7587       S += '?';
7588     }
7589     if (Options.ExpandStructures()) {
7590       S += '=';
7591       if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
7592         getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
7593       } else {
7594         for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
7595           if (FD) {
7596             S += '"';
7597             S += Field->getNameAsString();
7598             S += '"';
7599           }
7600 
7601           // Special case bit-fields.
7602           if (Field->isBitField()) {
7603             getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S,
7604                                        ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures(),
7605                                        Field);
7606           } else {
7607             QualType qt = Field->getType();
7608             getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
7609             getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
7610                 qt, S,
7611                 ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures().setIsStructField(), FD,
7612                 NotEncodedT);
7613           }
7614         }
7615       }
7616     }
7617     S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
7618     return;
7619   }
7620 
7621   case Type::BlockPointer: {
7622     const auto *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
7623     S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
7624     if (Options.EncodeBlockParameters()) {
7625       const auto *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
7626 
7627       S += '<';
7628       // Block return type
7629       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(FT->getReturnType(), S,
7630                                  Options.forComponentType(), FD, NotEncodedT);
7631       // Block self
7632       S += "@?";
7633       // Block parameters
7634       if (const auto *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
7635         for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
7636           getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(I, S, Options.forComponentType(), FD,
7637                                      NotEncodedT);
7638       }
7639       S += '>';
7640     }
7641     return;
7642   }
7643 
7644   case Type::ObjCObject: {
7645     // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
7646     QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
7647     if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
7648       S += "{objc_object=}";
7649       return;
7650     }
7651     else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
7652       S += "{objc_class=}";
7653       return;
7654     }
7655     // TODO: Double check to make sure this intentionally falls through.
7656     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
7657   }
7658 
7659   case Type::ObjCInterface: {
7660     // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
7661     // @encode(class_name)
7662     ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
7663     S += '{';
7664     S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
7665     if (Options.ExpandStructures()) {
7666       S += '=';
7667       SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
7668       DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
7669       for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
7670         const FieldDecl *Field = Ivars[i];
7671         if (Field->isBitField())
7672           getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S,
7673                                      ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures(),
7674                                      Field);
7675         else
7676           getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S,
7677                                      ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures(), FD,
7678                                      NotEncodedT);
7679       }
7680     }
7681     S += '}';
7682     return;
7683   }
7684 
7685   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
7686     const auto *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7687     if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
7688       S += '@';
7689       return;
7690     }
7691 
7692     if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
7693       // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
7694       // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with
7695       // runtime folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obscure construct.
7696       S += '#';
7697       return;
7698     }
7699 
7700     if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
7701       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
7702           getObjCIdType(), S,
7703           Options.keepingOnly(ObjCEncOptions()
7704                                   .setExpandPointedToStructures()
7705                                   .setExpandStructures()),
7706           FD);
7707       if (FD || Options.EncodingProperty() || Options.EncodeClassNames()) {
7708         // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
7709         // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
7710         S += '"';
7711         for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
7712           S += '<';
7713           S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
7714           S += '>';
7715         }
7716         S += '"';
7717       }
7718       return;
7719     }
7720 
7721     S += '@';
7722     if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
7723         (FD || Options.EncodingProperty() || Options.EncodeClassNames())) {
7724       S += '"';
7725       S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
7726       for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
7727         S += '<';
7728         S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
7729         S += '>';
7730       }
7731       S += '"';
7732     }
7733     return;
7734   }
7735 
7736   // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
7737   // FIXME: we should do better than that.  'M' is available.
7738   case Type::MemberPointer:
7739   // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
7740   //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
7741   case Type::Vector:
7742   case Type::ExtVector:
7743   // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
7744     if (NotEncodedT)
7745       *NotEncodedT = T;
7746     return;
7747 
7748   case Type::ConstantMatrix:
7749     if (NotEncodedT)
7750       *NotEncodedT = T;
7751     return;
7752 
7753   // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
7754   // Just ignore it.
7755   case Type::Auto:
7756   case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
7757     return;
7758 
7759   case Type::Pipe:
7760   case Type::ExtInt:
7761 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
7762 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
7763 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
7764   case Type::KIND:
7765 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
7766   case Type::KIND:
7767 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
7768   case Type::KIND:
7769 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
7770     llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
7771   }
7772   llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
7773 }
7774 
7775 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
7776                                                  std::string &S,
7777                                                  const FieldDecl *FD,
7778                                                  bool includeVBases,
7779                                                  QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
7780   assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
7781   assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
7782   if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
7783     return;
7784 
7785   const auto *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
7786   std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
7787   const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
7788 
7789   if (CXXRec) {
7790     for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
7791       if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
7792         CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
7793         if (base->isEmpty())
7794           continue;
7795         uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
7796         FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
7797                                   std::make_pair(offs, base));
7798       }
7799     }
7800   }
7801 
7802   unsigned i = 0;
7803   for (FieldDecl *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
7804     if (!Field->isZeroLengthBitField(*this) && Field->isZeroSize(*this))
7805       continue;
7806     uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
7807     FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
7808                               std::make_pair(offs, Field));
7809     ++i;
7810   }
7811 
7812   if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
7813     for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
7814       CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
7815       if (base->isEmpty())
7816         continue;
7817       uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
7818       if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
7819           FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
7820         FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
7821                                   std::make_pair(offs, base));
7822     }
7823   }
7824 
7825   CharUnits size;
7826   if (CXXRec) {
7827     size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
7828   } else {
7829     size = layout.getSize();
7830   }
7831 
7832 #ifndef NDEBUG
7833   uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
7834 #endif
7835   std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
7836     CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
7837 
7838   if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
7839       (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
7840     if (FD) {
7841       S += "\"_vptr$";
7842       std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
7843       if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
7844       S += recname;
7845       S += '"';
7846     }
7847     S += "^^?";
7848 #ifndef NDEBUG
7849     CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
7850 #endif
7851   }
7852 
7853   if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
7854     // Mark the end of the structure.
7855     uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
7856     FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
7857                               std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
7858   }
7859 
7860   for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
7861 #ifndef NDEBUG
7862     assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
7863     if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
7864       uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
7865       // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
7866       // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
7867       // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
7868       // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
7869       // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
7870       // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
7871       // longer then though.
7872       CurOffs += padding;
7873     }
7874 #endif
7875 
7876     NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
7877     if (!dcl)
7878       break; // reached end of structure.
7879 
7880     if (auto *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
7881       // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
7882       // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
7883       // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
7884       // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
7885       getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
7886                                       NotEncodedT);
7887       assert(!base->isEmpty());
7888 #ifndef NDEBUG
7889       CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
7890 #endif
7891     } else {
7892       const auto *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
7893       if (FD) {
7894         S += '"';
7895         S += field->getNameAsString();
7896         S += '"';
7897       }
7898 
7899       if (field->isBitField()) {
7900         EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
7901 #ifndef NDEBUG
7902         CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
7903 #endif
7904       } else {
7905         QualType qt = field->getType();
7906         getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
7907         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
7908             qt, S, ObjCEncOptions().setExpandStructures().setIsStructField(),
7909             FD, NotEncodedT);
7910 #ifndef NDEBUG
7911         CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
7912 #endif
7913       }
7914     }
7915   }
7916 }
7917 
7918 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
7919                                                  std::string& S) const {
7920   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
7921     S += 'n';
7922   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
7923     S += 'N';
7924   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
7925     S += 'o';
7926   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
7927     S += 'O';
7928   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
7929     S += 'R';
7930   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
7931     S += 'V';
7932 }
7933 
7934 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
7935   if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
7936     QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, {});
7937     T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
7938     ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
7939   }
7940   return ObjCIdDecl;
7941 }
7942 
7943 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
7944   if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
7945     QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
7946     ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
7947   }
7948   return ObjCSelDecl;
7949 }
7950 
7951 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
7952   if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
7953     QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, {});
7954     T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
7955     ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
7956   }
7957   return ObjCClassDecl;
7958 }
7959 
7960 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
7961   if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
7962     ObjCProtocolClassDecl
7963       = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
7964                                   SourceLocation(),
7965                                   &Idents.get("Protocol"),
7966                                   /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
7967                                   /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
7968                                   SourceLocation(), true);
7969   }
7970 
7971   return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
7972 }
7973 
7974 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7975 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
7976 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7977 
7978 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
7979                                                  StringRef Name) {
7980   // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
7981   QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
7982   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
7983 }
7984 
7985 static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
7986   return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
7987 }
7988 
7989 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
7990   return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
7991 }
7992 
7993 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
7994   // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
7995   QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7996   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
7997 }
7998 
7999 static TypedefDecl *
8000 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8001   // struct __va_list
8002   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
8003   if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8004     // namespace std { struct __va_list {
8005     NamespaceDecl *NS;
8006     NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
8007                                Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
8008                                /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
8009                                SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
8010                                /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
8011     NS->setImplicit();
8012     VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
8013   }
8014 
8015   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
8016 
8017   const size_t NumFields = 5;
8018   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
8019   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
8020 
8021   // void *__stack;
8022   FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8023   FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
8024 
8025   // void *__gr_top;
8026   FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8027   FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
8028 
8029   // void *__vr_top;
8030   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8031   FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
8032 
8033   // int __gr_offs;
8034   FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
8035   FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
8036 
8037   // int __vr_offs;
8038   FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
8039   FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
8040 
8041   // Create fields
8042   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
8043     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
8044                                          VaListTagDecl,
8045                                          SourceLocation(),
8046                                          SourceLocation(),
8047                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
8048                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
8049                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
8050                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
8051                                          ICIS_NoInit);
8052     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
8053     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
8054   }
8055   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
8056   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
8057   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
8058 
8059   // } __builtin_va_list;
8060   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
8061 }
8062 
8063 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8064   // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
8065   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
8066 
8067   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
8068   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
8069 
8070   const size_t NumFields = 5;
8071   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
8072   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
8073 
8074   //   unsigned char gpr;
8075   FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
8076   FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
8077 
8078   //   unsigned char fpr;
8079   FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
8080   FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
8081 
8082   //   unsigned short reserved;
8083   FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
8084   FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
8085 
8086   //   void* overflow_arg_area;
8087   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8088   FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
8089 
8090   //   void* reg_save_area;
8091   FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8092   FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
8093 
8094   // Create fields
8095   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
8096     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
8097                                          SourceLocation(),
8098                                          SourceLocation(),
8099                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
8100                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
8101                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
8102                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
8103                                          ICIS_NoInit);
8104     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
8105     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
8106   }
8107   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
8108   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
8109   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
8110 
8111   // } __va_list_tag;
8112   TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
8113       Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
8114 
8115   QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
8116     Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
8117 
8118   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
8119   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
8120   QualType VaListTagArrayType
8121     = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
8122                                     Size, nullptr, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
8123   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
8124 }
8125 
8126 static TypedefDecl *
8127 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8128   // struct __va_list_tag {
8129   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
8130   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
8131   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
8132 
8133   const size_t NumFields = 4;
8134   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
8135   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
8136 
8137   //   unsigned gp_offset;
8138   FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
8139   FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
8140 
8141   //   unsigned fp_offset;
8142   FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
8143   FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
8144 
8145   //   void* overflow_arg_area;
8146   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8147   FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
8148 
8149   //   void* reg_save_area;
8150   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8151   FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
8152 
8153   // Create fields
8154   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
8155     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
8156                                          VaListTagDecl,
8157                                          SourceLocation(),
8158                                          SourceLocation(),
8159                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
8160                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
8161                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
8162                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
8163                                          ICIS_NoInit);
8164     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
8165     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
8166   }
8167   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
8168   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
8169   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
8170 
8171   // };
8172 
8173   // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
8174   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
8175   QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
8176       VaListTagType, Size, nullptr, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
8177   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
8178 }
8179 
8180 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8181   // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
8182   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
8183   QualType IntArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
8184       Context->IntTy, Size, nullptr, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
8185   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
8186 }
8187 
8188 static TypedefDecl *
8189 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8190   // struct __va_list
8191   RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
8192   if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8193     // namespace std { struct __va_list {
8194     NamespaceDecl *NS;
8195     NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
8196                                Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
8197                                /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
8198                                SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
8199                                /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
8200     NS->setImplicit();
8201     VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
8202   }
8203 
8204   VaListDecl->startDefinition();
8205 
8206   // void * __ap;
8207   FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
8208                                        VaListDecl,
8209                                        SourceLocation(),
8210                                        SourceLocation(),
8211                                        &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
8212                                        Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
8213                                        /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
8214                                        /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
8215                                        /*Mutable=*/false,
8216                                        ICIS_NoInit);
8217   Field->setAccess(AS_public);
8218   VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
8219 
8220   // };
8221   VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
8222   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
8223 
8224   // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
8225   QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
8226   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
8227 }
8228 
8229 static TypedefDecl *
8230 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8231   // struct __va_list_tag {
8232   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
8233   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
8234   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
8235 
8236   const size_t NumFields = 4;
8237   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
8238   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
8239 
8240   //   long __gpr;
8241   FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
8242   FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
8243 
8244   //   long __fpr;
8245   FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
8246   FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
8247 
8248   //   void *__overflow_arg_area;
8249   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8250   FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
8251 
8252   //   void *__reg_save_area;
8253   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8254   FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
8255 
8256   // Create fields
8257   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
8258     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
8259                                          VaListTagDecl,
8260                                          SourceLocation(),
8261                                          SourceLocation(),
8262                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
8263                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
8264                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
8265                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
8266                                          ICIS_NoInit);
8267     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
8268     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
8269   }
8270   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
8271   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
8272   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
8273 
8274   // };
8275 
8276   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
8277   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
8278   QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
8279       VaListTagType, Size, nullptr, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
8280 
8281   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
8282 }
8283 
8284 static TypedefDecl *CreateHexagonBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
8285   // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
8286   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
8287   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
8288   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
8289 
8290   const size_t NumFields = 3;
8291   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
8292   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
8293 
8294   //   void *CurrentSavedRegisterArea;
8295   FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8296   FieldNames[0] = "__current_saved_reg_area_pointer";
8297 
8298   //   void *SavedRegAreaEnd;
8299   FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8300   FieldNames[1] = "__saved_reg_area_end_pointer";
8301 
8302   //   void *OverflowArea;
8303   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
8304   FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_area_pointer";
8305 
8306   // Create fields
8307   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
8308     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
8309         const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context), VaListTagDecl, SourceLocation(),
8310         SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i],
8311         /*TInfo=*/0,
8312         /*BitWidth=*/0,
8313         /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
8314     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
8315     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
8316   }
8317   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
8318   Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
8319   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
8320 
8321   // } __va_list_tag;
8322   TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
8323       Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
8324 
8325   QualType VaListTagTypedefType = Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
8326 
8327   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
8328   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
8329   QualType VaListTagArrayType = Context->getConstantArrayType(
8330       VaListTagTypedefType, Size, nullptr, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
8331 
8332   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
8333 }
8334 
8335 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
8336                                      TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
8337   switch (Kind) {
8338   case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
8339     return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8340   case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
8341     return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8342   case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
8343     return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8344   case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
8345     return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8346   case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
8347     return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8348   case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
8349     return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8350   case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
8351     return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8352   case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
8353     return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8354   case TargetInfo::HexagonBuiltinVaList:
8355     return CreateHexagonBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
8356   }
8357 
8358   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
8359 }
8360 
8361 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
8362   if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
8363     BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
8364     assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
8365   }
8366 
8367   return BuiltinVaListDecl;
8368 }
8369 
8370 Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
8371   // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
8372   // declaration.
8373   if (!VaListTagDecl)
8374     (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
8375 
8376   return VaListTagDecl;
8377 }
8378 
8379 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
8380   if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
8381     BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
8382 
8383   return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
8384 }
8385 
8386 bool ASTContext::canBuiltinBeRedeclared(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
8387   return BuiltinInfo.canBeRedeclared(FD->getBuiltinID());
8388 }
8389 
8390 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
8391   assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
8392          "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
8393 
8394   ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
8395 }
8396 
8397 /// Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
8398 /// lookup.
8399 TemplateName
8400 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
8401                                       UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
8402   unsigned size = End - Begin;
8403   assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
8404 
8405   void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
8406                           size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
8407   auto *OT = new (memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
8408 
8409   NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
8410   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
8411     NamedDecl *D = *I;
8412     assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
8413            isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D) ||
8414            (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
8415             isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
8416     *Storage++ = D;
8417   }
8418 
8419   return TemplateName(OT);
8420 }
8421 
8422 /// Retrieve a template name representing an unqualified-id that has been
8423 /// assumed to name a template for ADL purposes.
8424 TemplateName ASTContext::getAssumedTemplateName(DeclarationName Name) const {
8425   auto *OT = new (*this) AssumedTemplateStorage(Name);
8426   return TemplateName(OT);
8427 }
8428 
8429 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
8430 /// template name such as \c std::vector.
8431 TemplateName
8432 ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
8433                                      bool TemplateKeyword,
8434                                      TemplateDecl *Template) const {
8435   assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
8436 
8437   // FIXME: Canonicalization?
8438   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
8439   QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
8440 
8441   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
8442   QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
8443     QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
8444   if (!QTN) {
8445     QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
8446         QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
8447     QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
8448   }
8449 
8450   return TemplateName(QTN);
8451 }
8452 
8453 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
8454 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
8455 TemplateName
8456 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
8457                                      const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
8458   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
8459          "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
8460 
8461   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
8462   DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
8463 
8464   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
8465   DependentTemplateName *QTN =
8466     DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
8467 
8468   if (QTN)
8469     return TemplateName(QTN);
8470 
8471   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
8472   if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
8473     QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
8474         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
8475   } else {
8476     TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
8477     QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
8478         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
8479     DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
8480       DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
8481     assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
8482     (void)CheckQTN;
8483   }
8484 
8485   DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
8486   return TemplateName(QTN);
8487 }
8488 
8489 /// Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
8490 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
8491 TemplateName
8492 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
8493                                      OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
8494   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
8495          "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
8496 
8497   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
8498   DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
8499 
8500   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
8501   DependentTemplateName *QTN
8502     = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
8503 
8504   if (QTN)
8505     return TemplateName(QTN);
8506 
8507   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
8508   if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
8509     QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
8510         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
8511   } else {
8512     TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
8513     QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
8514         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
8515 
8516     DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
8517       = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
8518     assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
8519     (void)CheckQTN;
8520   }
8521 
8522   DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
8523   return TemplateName(QTN);
8524 }
8525 
8526 TemplateName
8527 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
8528                                          TemplateName replacement) const {
8529   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
8530   SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
8531 
8532   void *insertPos = nullptr;
8533   SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
8534     = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
8535 
8536   if (!subst) {
8537     subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
8538     SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
8539   }
8540 
8541   return TemplateName(subst);
8542 }
8543 
8544 TemplateName
8545 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
8546                                        const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
8547   auto &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
8548   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
8549   SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
8550 
8551   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
8552   SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
8553     = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
8554 
8555   if (!Subst) {
8556     Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
8557                                                            ArgPack.pack_size(),
8558                                                          ArgPack.pack_begin());
8559     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
8560   }
8561 
8562   return TemplateName(Subst);
8563 }
8564 
8565 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
8566 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
8567 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
8568 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
8569   switch (Type) {
8570   case TargetInfo::NoInt: return {};
8571   case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
8572   case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
8573   case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
8574   case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
8575   case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
8576   case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
8577   case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
8578   case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
8579   case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
8580   case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
8581   }
8582 
8583   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
8584 }
8585 
8586 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8587 //                        Type Predicates.
8588 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8589 
8590 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
8591 /// garbage collection attribute.
8592 ///
8593 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
8594   if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
8595     return Qualifiers::GCNone;
8596 
8597   assert(getLangOpts().ObjC);
8598   Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
8599 
8600   // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
8601   // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
8602   // as __strong.
8603   if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
8604     if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
8605       return Qualifiers::Strong;
8606     else if (Ty->isPointerType())
8607       return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
8608   } else {
8609     // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
8610     // pointer.
8611 #ifndef NDEBUG
8612     QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
8613     while (const auto *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
8614       CT = AT->getElementType();
8615     assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
8616 #endif
8617   }
8618   return GCAttrs;
8619 }
8620 
8621 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8622 //                        Type Compatibility Testing
8623 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8624 
8625 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
8626 /// compatible.
8627 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
8628                                  const VectorType *RHS) {
8629   assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
8630   return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
8631          LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
8632 }
8633 
8634 /// areCompatMatrixTypes - Return true if the two specified matrix types are
8635 /// compatible.
8636 static bool areCompatMatrixTypes(const ConstantMatrixType *LHS,
8637                                  const ConstantMatrixType *RHS) {
8638   assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
8639   return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
8640          LHS->getNumRows() == RHS->getNumRows() &&
8641          LHS->getNumColumns() == RHS->getNumColumns();
8642 }
8643 
8644 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
8645                                           QualType SecondVec) {
8646   assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
8647   assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
8648 
8649   if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
8650     return true;
8651 
8652   // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
8653   // equivalent GCC vector types.
8654   const auto *First = FirstVec->castAs<VectorType>();
8655   const auto *Second = SecondVec->castAs<VectorType>();
8656   if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
8657       hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
8658       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
8659       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
8660       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
8661       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
8662       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector &&
8663       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector &&
8664       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector &&
8665       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector)
8666     return true;
8667 
8668   return false;
8669 }
8670 
8671 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleSveTypes(QualType FirstType,
8672                                        QualType SecondType) {
8673   assert(((FirstType->isSizelessBuiltinType() && SecondType->isVectorType()) ||
8674           (FirstType->isVectorType() && SecondType->isSizelessBuiltinType())) &&
8675          "Expected SVE builtin type and vector type!");
8676 
8677   auto IsValidCast = [this](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
8678     if (const auto *BT = FirstType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
8679       if (const auto *VT = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
8680         // Predicates have the same representation as uint8 so we also have to
8681         // check the kind to make these types incompatible.
8682         if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector)
8683           return BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::SveBool;
8684         else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector)
8685           return VT->getElementType().getCanonicalType() ==
8686                  FirstType->getSveEltType(*this);
8687         else if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector)
8688           return getTypeSize(SecondType) == getLangOpts().ArmSveVectorBits &&
8689                  hasSameType(VT->getElementType(),
8690                              getBuiltinVectorTypeInfo(BT).ElementType);
8691       }
8692     }
8693     return false;
8694   };
8695 
8696   return IsValidCast(FirstType, SecondType) ||
8697          IsValidCast(SecondType, FirstType);
8698 }
8699 
8700 bool ASTContext::areLaxCompatibleSveTypes(QualType FirstType,
8701                                           QualType SecondType) {
8702   assert(((FirstType->isSizelessBuiltinType() && SecondType->isVectorType()) ||
8703           (FirstType->isVectorType() && SecondType->isSizelessBuiltinType())) &&
8704          "Expected SVE builtin type and vector type!");
8705 
8706   auto IsLaxCompatible = [this](QualType FirstType, QualType SecondType) {
8707     if (!FirstType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
8708       return false;
8709 
8710     const auto *VecTy = SecondType->getAs<VectorType>();
8711     if (VecTy &&
8712         (VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector ||
8713          VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector)) {
8714       const LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind LVCKind =
8715           getLangOpts().getLaxVectorConversions();
8716 
8717       // If __ARM_FEATURE_SVE_BITS != N do not allow GNU vector lax conversion.
8718       // "Whenever __ARM_FEATURE_SVE_BITS==N, GNUT implicitly
8719       // converts to VLAT and VLAT implicitly converts to GNUT."
8720       // ACLE Spec Version 00bet6, 3.7.3.2. Behavior common to vectors and
8721       // predicates.
8722       if (VecTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector &&
8723           getTypeSize(SecondType) != getLangOpts().ArmSveVectorBits)
8724         return false;
8725 
8726       // If -flax-vector-conversions=all is specified, the types are
8727       // certainly compatible.
8728       if (LVCKind == LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::All)
8729         return true;
8730 
8731       // If -flax-vector-conversions=integer is specified, the types are
8732       // compatible if the elements are integer types.
8733       if (LVCKind == LangOptions::LaxVectorConversionKind::Integer)
8734         return VecTy->getElementType().getCanonicalType()->isIntegerType() &&
8735                FirstType->getSveEltType(*this)->isIntegerType();
8736     }
8737 
8738     return false;
8739   };
8740 
8741   return IsLaxCompatible(FirstType, SecondType) ||
8742          IsLaxCompatible(SecondType, FirstType);
8743 }
8744 
8745 bool ASTContext::hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(QualType Ty) const {
8746   while (true) {
8747     // __strong id
8748     if (const AttributedType *Attr = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Ty)) {
8749       if (Attr->getAttrKind() == attr::ObjCOwnership)
8750         return true;
8751 
8752       Ty = Attr->getModifiedType();
8753 
8754     // X *__strong (...)
8755     } else if (const ParenType *Paren = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) {
8756       Ty = Paren->getInnerType();
8757 
8758     // We do not want to look through typedefs, typeof(expr),
8759     // typeof(type), or any other way that the type is somehow
8760     // abstracted.
8761     } else {
8762       return false;
8763     }
8764   }
8765 }
8766 
8767 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8768 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
8769 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8770 
8771 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
8772 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
8773 bool
8774 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
8775                                            ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
8776   if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
8777     return true;
8778   for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
8779     if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
8780       return true;
8781   return false;
8782 }
8783 
8784 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare  Class<pr,...> and
8785 /// Class<pr1, ...>.
8786 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(
8787     const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhs, const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhs) {
8788   for (auto *lhsProto : lhs->quals()) {
8789     bool match = false;
8790     for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
8791       if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
8792         match = true;
8793         break;
8794       }
8795     }
8796     if (!match)
8797       return false;
8798   }
8799   return true;
8800 }
8801 
8802 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
8803 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
8804 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(
8805     const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhs, const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhs,
8806     bool compare) {
8807   // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' in all cases.
8808   if (lhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCIdType())
8809     return true;
8810 
8811   // Don't allow id<P..> to convert to Class or Class<P..> in either direction.
8812   if (lhs->isObjCClassType() || lhs->isObjCQualifiedClassType() ||
8813       rhs->isObjCClassType() || rhs->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
8814     return false;
8815 
8816   if (lhs->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
8817     if (rhs->qual_empty()) {
8818       // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
8819       // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
8820       if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhs->getInterfaceDecl()) {
8821         for (auto *I : lhs->quals()) {
8822           // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
8823           // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
8824           // through its super class and categories.
8825           if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
8826             return false;
8827         }
8828       }
8829       // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
8830       return true;
8831     }
8832     // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
8833     for (auto *lhsProto : lhs->quals()) {
8834       bool match = false;
8835 
8836       // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
8837       // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
8838       // through its super class and categories.
8839       for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
8840         if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
8841             (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
8842           match = true;
8843           break;
8844         }
8845       }
8846       // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
8847       // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
8848       if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhs->getInterfaceDecl()) {
8849         for (auto *I : lhs->quals()) {
8850           // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
8851           // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
8852           // through its super class and categories.
8853           if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
8854             match = true;
8855             break;
8856           }
8857         }
8858       }
8859       if (!match)
8860         return false;
8861     }
8862 
8863     return true;
8864   }
8865 
8866   assert(rhs->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
8867 
8868   if (lhs->getInterfaceType()) {
8869     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
8870     for (auto *lhsProto : lhs->quals()) {
8871       bool match = false;
8872 
8873       // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
8874       // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
8875       // through its super class and categories.
8876       // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
8877       // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
8878       for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
8879         if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
8880             (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
8881           match = true;
8882           break;
8883         }
8884       }
8885       if (!match)
8886         return false;
8887     }
8888 
8889     // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
8890     // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
8891     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhs->getInterfaceDecl()) {
8892       llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
8893       CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
8894       // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
8895       // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
8896       // assume that it is mismatch.
8897       if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhs->qual_empty())
8898         return false;
8899       for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
8900         bool match = false;
8901         for (auto *rhsProto : rhs->quals()) {
8902           if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
8903               (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
8904             match = true;
8905             break;
8906           }
8907         }
8908         if (!match)
8909           return false;
8910       }
8911     }
8912     return true;
8913   }
8914   return false;
8915 }
8916 
8917 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
8918 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS.  This handles validation of any
8919 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
8920 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
8921                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
8922   const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
8923   const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
8924 
8925   // If either type represents the built-in 'id' type, return true.
8926   if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedId())
8927     return true;
8928 
8929   // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
8930   // __kindof types.
8931   auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
8932     if (succeeded)
8933       return true;
8934 
8935     if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
8936       return false;
8937 
8938     // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
8939     // we can assign the other way.
8940     return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
8941                                    LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
8942   };
8943 
8944   // Casts from or to id<P> are allowed when the other side has compatible
8945   // protocols.
8946   if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
8947     return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT, false));
8948   }
8949 
8950   // Verify protocol compatibility for casts from Class<P1> to Class<P2>.
8951   if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
8952     return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT));
8953   }
8954 
8955   // Casts from Class to Class<Foo>, or vice-versa, are allowed.
8956   if (LHS->isObjCClass() && RHS->isObjCClass()) {
8957     return true;
8958   }
8959 
8960   // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
8961   if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
8962     return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
8963   }
8964 
8965   return false;
8966 }
8967 
8968 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
8969 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
8970 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
8971 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
8972 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
8973 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8974                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
8975                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
8976                                          bool BlockReturnType) {
8977 
8978   // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
8979   // __kindof types.
8980   auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
8981     if (succeeded)
8982       return true;
8983 
8984     const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
8985     if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
8986       return false;
8987 
8988     // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
8989     // we can assign the other way.
8990     return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8991              RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
8992              LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
8993              BlockReturnType);
8994   };
8995 
8996   if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
8997     return true;
8998 
8999   if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
9000     return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
9001                   RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
9002   }
9003 
9004   if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
9005     if (getLangOpts().CompatibilityQualifiedIdBlockParamTypeChecking)
9006       // Use for block parameters previous type checking for compatibility.
9007       return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT, false) ||
9008                     // Or corrected type checking as in non-compat mode.
9009                     (!BlockReturnType &&
9010                      ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(RHSOPT, LHSOPT, false)));
9011     else
9012       return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(
9013           (BlockReturnType ? LHSOPT : RHSOPT),
9014           (BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT), false));
9015   }
9016 
9017   const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
9018   const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
9019   if (LHS && RHS)  { // We have 2 user-defined types.
9020     if (LHS != RHS) {
9021       if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
9022         return finish(BlockReturnType);
9023       if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
9024         return finish(!BlockReturnType);
9025     }
9026     else
9027       return true;
9028   }
9029   return false;
9030 }
9031 
9032 /// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
9033 /// llvm::array_pod_sort.
9034 static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
9035                                       ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
9036   return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
9037 }
9038 
9039 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
9040 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
9041 /// the given common base.
9042 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
9043 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
9044 static
9045 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
9046                                 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
9047                                 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
9048                                 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
9049       SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
9050 
9051   const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
9052   const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
9053   assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
9054   assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
9055 
9056   // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
9057   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
9058 
9059   // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
9060   for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
9061     Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
9062   }
9063 
9064   // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
9065   Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
9066 
9067   // Add all of the protocols for the RHS.
9068   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
9069 
9070   // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
9071   for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
9072     Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
9073   }
9074 
9075   // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
9076   Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
9077 
9078   // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
9079   for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
9080     if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
9081       IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
9082   }
9083 
9084   // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
9085   // the protocols within the intersection.
9086   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
9087   Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
9088 
9089   // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
9090   if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
9091     IntersectionSet.erase(
9092       std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
9093                      IntersectionSet.end(),
9094                      [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
9095                        return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
9096                      }),
9097       IntersectionSet.end());
9098   }
9099 
9100   // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
9101   llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
9102                        compareObjCProtocolsByName);
9103 }
9104 
9105 /// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
9106 static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
9107                                      QualType rhs) {
9108   // Common case: two object pointers.
9109   const auto *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
9110   const auto *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
9111   if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
9112     return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
9113 
9114   // Two block pointers.
9115   const auto *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
9116   const auto *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
9117   if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
9118     return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
9119 
9120   // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
9121   // acceptable.
9122   if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
9123       (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
9124     return true;
9125 
9126   return false;
9127 }
9128 
9129 // Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
9130 static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
9131                              const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
9132                              ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
9133                              ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
9134                              bool stripKindOf) {
9135   if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
9136     return false;
9137 
9138   ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
9139   for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
9140     if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
9141       continue;
9142 
9143     switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
9144     case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
9145       if (!stripKindOf ||
9146           !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
9147                            rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
9148         return false;
9149       }
9150       break;
9151 
9152     case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
9153       if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
9154         return false;
9155       break;
9156 
9157     case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
9158       if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
9159         return false;
9160       break;
9161     }
9162   }
9163 
9164   return true;
9165 }
9166 
9167 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
9168            const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
9169            const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
9170   const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
9171   const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
9172   const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
9173   const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
9174 
9175   if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
9176     return {};
9177 
9178   // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
9179   // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
9180   // kindof(A).
9181   bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
9182 
9183   // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
9184   // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
9185   llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
9186     LHSAncestors;
9187   while (true) {
9188     // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
9189     // path from the LHS to the root.
9190     LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
9191 
9192     if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
9193       // Get the type arguments.
9194       ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
9195       bool anyChanges = false;
9196       if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
9197         // Both have type arguments, compare them.
9198         if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
9199                               LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
9200                               /*stripKindOf=*/true))
9201           return {};
9202       } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
9203         // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
9204         // arguments.
9205         LHSTypeArgs = {};
9206         anyChanges = true;
9207       }
9208 
9209       // Compute the intersection of protocols.
9210       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
9211       getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
9212                                  Protocols);
9213       if (!Protocols.empty())
9214         anyChanges = true;
9215 
9216       // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
9217       // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
9218       // build a new result type.
9219       if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
9220         QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
9221         Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
9222                                    anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
9223         return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
9224       }
9225 
9226       return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
9227     }
9228 
9229     // Find the superclass.
9230     QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
9231     if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
9232       break;
9233 
9234     LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
9235   }
9236 
9237   // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
9238   // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
9239   while (true) {
9240     auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
9241     if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
9242       LHS = KnownLHS->second;
9243 
9244       // Get the type arguments.
9245       ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
9246       bool anyChanges = false;
9247       if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
9248         // Both have type arguments, compare them.
9249         if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
9250                               LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
9251                               /*stripKindOf=*/true))
9252           return {};
9253       } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
9254         // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
9255         // arguments.
9256         RHSTypeArgs = {};
9257         anyChanges = true;
9258       }
9259 
9260       // Compute the intersection of protocols.
9261       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
9262       getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
9263                                  Protocols);
9264       if (!Protocols.empty())
9265         anyChanges = true;
9266 
9267       // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
9268       // build a new result type.
9269       if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
9270         QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
9271         Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
9272                                    anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
9273         return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
9274       }
9275 
9276       return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
9277     }
9278 
9279     // Find the superclass of the RHS.
9280     QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
9281     if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
9282       break;
9283 
9284     RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
9285   }
9286 
9287   return {};
9288 }
9289 
9290 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
9291                                          const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
9292   assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
9293   assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
9294 
9295   // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
9296   // the LHS.
9297   ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
9298   bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
9299   if (!IsSuperClass)
9300     return false;
9301 
9302   // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
9303   // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
9304   // LHS).
9305   if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
9306     // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
9307     // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
9308     // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
9309     // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
9310     llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
9311     CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
9312     // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
9313     // qualifiers.
9314     for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
9315       CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
9316     // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
9317     if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
9318       return false;
9319 
9320     for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
9321       bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
9322       for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
9323         if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
9324           SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
9325           break;
9326         }
9327       if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
9328         return false;
9329     }
9330   }
9331 
9332   // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
9333   if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
9334     // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
9335     // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
9336     const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
9337     while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
9338       RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
9339 
9340     // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
9341     if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
9342         !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
9343                           LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
9344                           /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
9345       return false;
9346     }
9347   }
9348 
9349   return true;
9350 }
9351 
9352 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
9353   // get the "pointed to" types
9354   const auto *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
9355   const auto *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
9356 
9357   if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
9358     return false;
9359 
9360   return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
9361          canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
9362 }
9363 
9364 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
9365   return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
9366       getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
9367       getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
9368 }
9369 
9370 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
9371 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
9372 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
9373 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
9374 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
9375                                     bool CompareUnqualified) {
9376   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
9377     return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
9378 
9379   return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
9380 }
9381 
9382 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
9383   return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
9384 }
9385 
9386 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
9387   return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
9388 }
9389 
9390 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
9391 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
9392 /// QualType()
9393 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
9394                                                bool OfBlockPointer,
9395                                                bool Unqualified) {
9396   if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
9397     RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
9398     if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
9399       for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
9400         QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
9401         QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
9402         if (!MT.isNull())
9403           return MT;
9404       }
9405     }
9406   }
9407 
9408   return {};
9409 }
9410 
9411 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
9412 /// parameter types
9413 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
9414                                                  bool OfBlockPointer,
9415                                                  bool Unqualified) {
9416   // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
9417   // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
9418   // type is compatible with a union member
9419   QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
9420                                               Unqualified);
9421   if (!lmerge.isNull())
9422     return lmerge;
9423 
9424   QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
9425                                               Unqualified);
9426   if (!rmerge.isNull())
9427     return rmerge;
9428 
9429   return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
9430 }
9431 
9432 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
9433                                         bool OfBlockPointer, bool Unqualified,
9434                                         bool AllowCXX) {
9435   const auto *lbase = lhs->castAs<FunctionType>();
9436   const auto *rbase = rhs->castAs<FunctionType>();
9437   const auto *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
9438   const auto *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
9439   bool allLTypes = true;
9440   bool allRTypes = true;
9441 
9442   // Check return type
9443   QualType retType;
9444   if (OfBlockPointer) {
9445     QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
9446     QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
9447     bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
9448     if (!UnqualifiedResult)
9449       UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
9450     retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
9451   }
9452   else
9453     retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
9454                          Unqualified);
9455   if (retType.isNull())
9456     return {};
9457 
9458   if (Unqualified)
9459     retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
9460 
9461   CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
9462   CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
9463   if (Unqualified) {
9464     LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
9465     RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
9466   }
9467 
9468   if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
9469     allLTypes = false;
9470   if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
9471     allRTypes = false;
9472 
9473   // FIXME: double check this
9474   // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
9475   //                           rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
9476   //                           lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
9477   FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
9478   FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
9479 
9480   // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
9481   if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
9482     return {};
9483 
9484   // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
9485   if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
9486     return {};
9487   if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
9488     return {};
9489 
9490   if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
9491     return {};
9492   if (lbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != rbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs())
9493     return {};
9494   if (lbaseInfo.getNoCfCheck() != rbaseInfo.getNoCfCheck())
9495     return {};
9496 
9497   // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
9498   bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
9499 
9500   if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
9501     allLTypes = false;
9502   if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
9503     allRTypes = false;
9504 
9505   FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
9506 
9507   if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
9508     assert((AllowCXX ||
9509             (!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec())) &&
9510            "C++ shouldn't be here");
9511     // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
9512     if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
9513       return {};
9514 
9515     // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
9516     if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
9517       return {};
9518 
9519     if (lproto->getMethodQuals() != rproto->getMethodQuals())
9520       return {};
9521 
9522     SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> newParamInfos;
9523     bool canUseLeft, canUseRight;
9524     if (!mergeExtParameterInfo(lproto, rproto, canUseLeft, canUseRight,
9525                                newParamInfos))
9526       return {};
9527 
9528     if (!canUseLeft)
9529       allLTypes = false;
9530     if (!canUseRight)
9531       allRTypes = false;
9532 
9533     // Check parameter type compatibility
9534     SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
9535     for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
9536       QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
9537       QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
9538       QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
9539           lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
9540       if (paramType.isNull())
9541         return {};
9542 
9543       if (Unqualified)
9544         paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
9545 
9546       types.push_back(paramType);
9547       if (Unqualified) {
9548         lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
9549         rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
9550       }
9551 
9552       if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
9553         allLTypes = false;
9554       if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
9555         allRTypes = false;
9556     }
9557 
9558     if (allLTypes) return lhs;
9559     if (allRTypes) return rhs;
9560 
9561     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
9562     EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
9563     EPI.ExtParameterInfos =
9564         newParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : newParamInfos.data();
9565     return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
9566   }
9567 
9568   if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
9569   if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
9570 
9571   const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
9572   if (proto) {
9573     assert((AllowCXX || !proto->hasExceptionSpec()) && "C++ shouldn't be here");
9574     if (proto->isVariadic())
9575       return {};
9576     // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
9577     // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
9578     // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
9579     // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
9580     // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
9581     for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
9582       QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
9583 
9584       // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
9585       // to pass enum values.
9586       if (const auto *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
9587         paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
9588         if (paramTy.isNull())
9589           return {};
9590       }
9591 
9592       if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
9593           getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
9594         return {};
9595     }
9596 
9597     if (allLTypes) return lhs;
9598     if (allRTypes) return rhs;
9599 
9600     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
9601     EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
9602     return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
9603   }
9604 
9605   if (allLTypes) return lhs;
9606   if (allRTypes) return rhs;
9607   return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
9608 }
9609 
9610 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
9611 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
9612                                      QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
9613   // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
9614   // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
9615   // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
9616   // type.
9617   QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
9618   if (underlyingType.isNull())
9619     return {};
9620   if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
9621     return other;
9622 
9623   // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
9624   // integral type of the same size.
9625   if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
9626       Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
9627     return other;
9628 
9629   return {};
9630 }
9631 
9632 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
9633                                 bool OfBlockPointer,
9634                                 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
9635   // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
9636   // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
9637   // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
9638   // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
9639   // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
9640   if (LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() || RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9641     return {};
9642 
9643   if (Unqualified) {
9644     LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
9645     RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
9646   }
9647 
9648   QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
9649            RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
9650 
9651   // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
9652   if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
9653     return LHS;
9654 
9655   // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
9656   Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
9657   Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
9658   if (LQuals != RQuals) {
9659     // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
9660     // mismatch.
9661     if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
9662         LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
9663         LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime() ||
9664         LQuals.hasUnaligned() != RQuals.hasUnaligned())
9665       return {};
9666 
9667     // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
9668     // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
9669     // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default).  We fix
9670     // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
9671     // qualified __strong.
9672     Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
9673     Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
9674     assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
9675 
9676     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
9677       return {};
9678 
9679     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9680       return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
9681     }
9682     if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9683       return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
9684     }
9685     return {};
9686   }
9687 
9688   // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
9689 
9690   Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
9691   Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
9692 
9693   // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
9694   // comparisons, just force one to the other.
9695   if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
9696   if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
9697 
9698   // Same as above for arrays
9699   if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
9700     LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
9701   if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
9702     RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
9703 
9704   // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
9705   if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
9706   if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
9707 
9708   // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
9709   if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
9710   if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
9711 
9712   // If the canonical type classes don't match.
9713   if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
9714     // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
9715     // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
9716     if (const auto *ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
9717       return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
9718     }
9719     if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
9720       return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
9721     }
9722     // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
9723     if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
9724        if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
9725          return LHS;
9726       if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
9727         return RHS;
9728     }
9729 
9730     return {};
9731   }
9732 
9733   // The canonical type classes match.
9734   switch (LHSClass) {
9735 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
9736 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
9737 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
9738 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
9739 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
9740 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.inc"
9741     llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
9742 
9743   case Type::Auto:
9744   case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
9745   case Type::LValueReference:
9746   case Type::RValueReference:
9747   case Type::MemberPointer:
9748     llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
9749 
9750   case Type::ObjCInterface:
9751   case Type::IncompleteArray:
9752   case Type::VariableArray:
9753   case Type::FunctionProto:
9754   case Type::ExtVector:
9755     llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
9756 
9757   case Type::Pointer:
9758   {
9759     // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
9760     QualType LHSPointee = LHS->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9761     QualType RHSPointee = RHS->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9762     if (Unqualified) {
9763       LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
9764       RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
9765     }
9766     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
9767                                      Unqualified);
9768     if (ResultType.isNull())
9769       return {};
9770     if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9771       return LHS;
9772     if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9773       return RHS;
9774     return getPointerType(ResultType);
9775   }
9776   case Type::BlockPointer:
9777   {
9778     // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
9779     QualType LHSPointee = LHS->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9780     QualType RHSPointee = RHS->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9781     if (Unqualified) {
9782       LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
9783       RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
9784     }
9785     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
9786       Qualifiers LHSPteeQual = LHSPointee.getQualifiers();
9787       Qualifiers RHSPteeQual = RHSPointee.getQualifiers();
9788       // Blocks can't be an expression in a ternary operator (OpenCL v2.0
9789       // 6.12.5) thus the following check is asymmetric.
9790       if (!LHSPteeQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RHSPteeQual))
9791         return {};
9792       LHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
9793       RHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
9794       LHSPointee =
9795           QualType(LHSPointee.getTypePtr(), LHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
9796       RHSPointee =
9797           QualType(RHSPointee.getTypePtr(), RHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
9798     }
9799     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
9800                                      Unqualified);
9801     if (ResultType.isNull())
9802       return {};
9803     if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9804       return LHS;
9805     if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9806       return RHS;
9807     return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
9808   }
9809   case Type::Atomic:
9810   {
9811     // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
9812     QualType LHSValue = LHS->castAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
9813     QualType RHSValue = RHS->castAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
9814     if (Unqualified) {
9815       LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
9816       RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
9817     }
9818     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
9819                                      Unqualified);
9820     if (ResultType.isNull())
9821       return {};
9822     if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9823       return LHS;
9824     if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9825       return RHS;
9826     return getAtomicType(ResultType);
9827   }
9828   case Type::ConstantArray:
9829   {
9830     const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
9831     const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
9832     if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
9833       return {};
9834 
9835     QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
9836     QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
9837     if (Unqualified) {
9838       LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
9839       RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
9840     }
9841 
9842     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
9843     if (ResultType.isNull())
9844       return {};
9845 
9846     const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
9847     const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
9848 
9849     // If either side is a variable array, and both are complete, check whether
9850     // the current dimension is definite.
9851     if (LVAT || RVAT) {
9852       auto SizeFetch = [this](const VariableArrayType* VAT,
9853           const ConstantArrayType* CAT)
9854           -> std::pair<bool,llvm::APInt> {
9855         if (VAT) {
9856           Optional<llvm::APSInt> TheInt;
9857           Expr *E = VAT->getSizeExpr();
9858           if (E && (TheInt = E->getIntegerConstantExpr(*this)))
9859             return std::make_pair(true, *TheInt);
9860           return std::make_pair(false, llvm::APSInt());
9861         }
9862         if (CAT)
9863           return std::make_pair(true, CAT->getSize());
9864         return std::make_pair(false, llvm::APInt());
9865       };
9866 
9867       bool HaveLSize, HaveRSize;
9868       llvm::APInt LSize, RSize;
9869       std::tie(HaveLSize, LSize) = SizeFetch(LVAT, LCAT);
9870       std::tie(HaveRSize, RSize) = SizeFetch(RVAT, RCAT);
9871       if (HaveLSize && HaveRSize && !llvm::APInt::isSameValue(LSize, RSize))
9872         return {}; // Definite, but unequal, array dimension
9873     }
9874 
9875     if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9876       return LHS;
9877     if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9878       return RHS;
9879     if (LCAT)
9880       return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
9881                                   LCAT->getSizeExpr(),
9882                                   ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
9883     if (RCAT)
9884       return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
9885                                   RCAT->getSizeExpr(),
9886                                   ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
9887     if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9888       return LHS;
9889     if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
9890       return RHS;
9891     if (LVAT) {
9892       // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
9893       // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
9894       // has to be different.
9895       return LHS;
9896     }
9897     if (RVAT) {
9898       // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
9899       // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
9900       // has to be different.
9901       return RHS;
9902     }
9903     if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
9904     if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
9905     return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
9906                                   ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
9907   }
9908   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
9909     return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
9910   case Type::Record:
9911   case Type::Enum:
9912     return {};
9913   case Type::Builtin:
9914     // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
9915     return {};
9916   case Type::Complex:
9917     // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
9918     return {};
9919   case Type::Vector:
9920     // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
9921     if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->castAs<VectorType>(),
9922                              RHSCan->castAs<VectorType>()))
9923       return LHS;
9924     return {};
9925   case Type::ConstantMatrix:
9926     if (areCompatMatrixTypes(LHSCan->castAs<ConstantMatrixType>(),
9927                              RHSCan->castAs<ConstantMatrixType>()))
9928       return LHS;
9929     return {};
9930   case Type::ObjCObject: {
9931     // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
9932     // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
9933     // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
9934     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectType>(),
9935                                 RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()))
9936       return LHS;
9937     return {};
9938   }
9939   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
9940     if (OfBlockPointer) {
9941       if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
9942               LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
9943               RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), BlockReturnType))
9944         return LHS;
9945       return {};
9946     }
9947     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
9948                                 RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
9949       return LHS;
9950     return {};
9951   case Type::Pipe:
9952     assert(LHS != RHS &&
9953            "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!");
9954     return {};
9955   case Type::ExtInt: {
9956     // Merge two ext-int types, while trying to preserve typedef info.
9957     bool LHSUnsigned  = LHS->castAs<ExtIntType>()->isUnsigned();
9958     bool RHSUnsigned = RHS->castAs<ExtIntType>()->isUnsigned();
9959     unsigned LHSBits = LHS->castAs<ExtIntType>()->getNumBits();
9960     unsigned RHSBits = RHS->castAs<ExtIntType>()->getNumBits();
9961 
9962     // Like unsigned/int, shouldn't have a type if they dont match.
9963     if (LHSUnsigned != RHSUnsigned)
9964       return {};
9965 
9966     if (LHSBits != RHSBits)
9967       return {};
9968     return LHS;
9969   }
9970   }
9971 
9972   llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
9973 }
9974 
9975 bool ASTContext::mergeExtParameterInfo(
9976     const FunctionProtoType *FirstFnType, const FunctionProtoType *SecondFnType,
9977     bool &CanUseFirst, bool &CanUseSecond,
9978     SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> &NewParamInfos) {
9979   assert(NewParamInfos.empty() && "param info list not empty");
9980   CanUseFirst = CanUseSecond = true;
9981   bool FirstHasInfo = FirstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
9982   bool SecondHasInfo = SecondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
9983 
9984   // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
9985   // we match if and only if the second type also doesn't have them.
9986   if (!FirstHasInfo && !SecondHasInfo)
9987     return true;
9988 
9989   bool NeedParamInfo = false;
9990   size_t E = FirstHasInfo ? FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size()
9991                           : SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size();
9992 
9993   for (size_t I = 0; I < E; ++I) {
9994     FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo FirstParam, SecondParam;
9995     if (FirstHasInfo)
9996       FirstParam = FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
9997     if (SecondHasInfo)
9998       SecondParam = SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
9999 
10000     // Cannot merge unless everything except the noescape flag matches.
10001     if (FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(false) != SecondParam.withIsNoEscape(false))
10002       return false;
10003 
10004     bool FirstNoEscape = FirstParam.isNoEscape();
10005     bool SecondNoEscape = SecondParam.isNoEscape();
10006     bool IsNoEscape = FirstNoEscape && SecondNoEscape;
10007     NewParamInfos.push_back(FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(IsNoEscape));
10008     if (NewParamInfos.back().getOpaqueValue())
10009       NeedParamInfo = true;
10010     if (FirstNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
10011       CanUseFirst = false;
10012     if (SecondNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
10013       CanUseSecond = false;
10014   }
10015 
10016   if (!NeedParamInfo)
10017     NewParamInfos.clear();
10018 
10019   return true;
10020 }
10021 
10022 void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
10023   ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
10024 }
10025 
10026 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
10027 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
10028 /// return types.
10029 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
10030   QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
10031   RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
10032   // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
10033   if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
10034     return LHS;
10035   if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
10036     if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
10037       return {};
10038     QualType OldReturnType =
10039         cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
10040     QualType NewReturnType =
10041         cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
10042     QualType ResReturnType =
10043       mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
10044     if (ResReturnType.isNull())
10045       return {};
10046     if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
10047       // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
10048       // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
10049       const auto *F = LHS->castAs<FunctionType>();
10050       if (const auto *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
10051         FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
10052         EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
10053         QualType ResultType =
10054             getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
10055         return ResultType;
10056       }
10057     }
10058     return {};
10059   }
10060 
10061   // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
10062   Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
10063   Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
10064   if (LQuals != RQuals) {
10065     // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
10066     if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
10067         LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
10068       return {};
10069 
10070     // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
10071     // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
10072     // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default).  We fix
10073     // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
10074     // qualified __strong.
10075     Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
10076     Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
10077     assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
10078 
10079     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
10080       return {};
10081 
10082     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
10083       return LHS;
10084     if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
10085       return RHS;
10086     return {};
10087   }
10088 
10089   if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
10090     QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10091     QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10092     QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
10093     if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
10094       return LHS;
10095     if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
10096       return RHS;
10097   }
10098   return {};
10099 }
10100 
10101 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10102 //                         Integer Predicates
10103 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10104 
10105 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
10106   if (const auto *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
10107     T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
10108   if (T->isBooleanType())
10109     return 1;
10110   if(const auto *EIT = T->getAs<ExtIntType>())
10111     return EIT->getNumBits();
10112   // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
10113   return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
10114 }
10115 
10116 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
10117   assert((T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() || T->isSignedFixedPointType()) &&
10118          "Unexpected type");
10119 
10120   // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
10121   if (const auto *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
10122     return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
10123                          VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
10124 
10125   // For _ExtInt, return an unsigned _ExtInt with same width.
10126   if (const auto *EITy = T->getAs<ExtIntType>())
10127     return getExtIntType(/*IsUnsigned=*/true, EITy->getNumBits());
10128 
10129   // For enums, get the underlying integer type of the enum, and let the general
10130   // integer type signchanging code handle it.
10131   if (const auto *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
10132     T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
10133 
10134   switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
10135   case BuiltinType::Char_S:
10136   case BuiltinType::SChar:
10137     return UnsignedCharTy;
10138   case BuiltinType::Short:
10139     return UnsignedShortTy;
10140   case BuiltinType::Int:
10141     return UnsignedIntTy;
10142   case BuiltinType::Long:
10143     return UnsignedLongTy;
10144   case BuiltinType::LongLong:
10145     return UnsignedLongLongTy;
10146   case BuiltinType::Int128:
10147     return UnsignedInt128Ty;
10148   // wchar_t is special. It is either signed or not, but when it's signed,
10149   // there's no matching "unsigned wchar_t". Therefore we return the unsigned
10150   // version of it's underlying type instead.
10151   case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
10152     return getUnsignedWCharType();
10153 
10154   case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
10155     return UnsignedShortAccumTy;
10156   case BuiltinType::Accum:
10157     return UnsignedAccumTy;
10158   case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
10159     return UnsignedLongAccumTy;
10160   case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
10161     return SatUnsignedShortAccumTy;
10162   case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
10163     return SatUnsignedAccumTy;
10164   case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
10165     return SatUnsignedLongAccumTy;
10166   case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
10167     return UnsignedShortFractTy;
10168   case BuiltinType::Fract:
10169     return UnsignedFractTy;
10170   case BuiltinType::LongFract:
10171     return UnsignedLongFractTy;
10172   case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
10173     return SatUnsignedShortFractTy;
10174   case BuiltinType::SatFract:
10175     return SatUnsignedFractTy;
10176   case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
10177     return SatUnsignedLongFractTy;
10178   default:
10179     llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer or fixed point type");
10180   }
10181 }
10182 
10183 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSignedType(QualType T) const {
10184   assert((T->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() ||
10185           T->isUnsignedFixedPointType()) &&
10186          "Unexpected type");
10187 
10188   // Turn <4 x unsigned int> -> <4 x signed int>
10189   if (const auto *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
10190     return getVectorType(getCorrespondingSignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
10191                          VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
10192 
10193   // For _ExtInt, return a signed _ExtInt with same width.
10194   if (const auto *EITy = T->getAs<ExtIntType>())
10195     return getExtIntType(/*IsUnsigned=*/false, EITy->getNumBits());
10196 
10197   // For enums, get the underlying integer type of the enum, and let the general
10198   // integer type signchanging code handle it.
10199   if (const auto *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
10200     T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
10201 
10202   switch (T->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
10203   case BuiltinType::Char_U:
10204   case BuiltinType::UChar:
10205     return SignedCharTy;
10206   case BuiltinType::UShort:
10207     return ShortTy;
10208   case BuiltinType::UInt:
10209     return IntTy;
10210   case BuiltinType::ULong:
10211     return LongTy;
10212   case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
10213     return LongLongTy;
10214   case BuiltinType::UInt128:
10215     return Int128Ty;
10216   // wchar_t is special. It is either unsigned or not, but when it's unsigned,
10217   // there's no matching "signed wchar_t". Therefore we return the signed
10218   // version of it's underlying type instead.
10219   case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
10220     return getSignedWCharType();
10221 
10222   case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
10223     return ShortAccumTy;
10224   case BuiltinType::UAccum:
10225     return AccumTy;
10226   case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
10227     return LongAccumTy;
10228   case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
10229     return SatShortAccumTy;
10230   case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
10231     return SatAccumTy;
10232   case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
10233     return SatLongAccumTy;
10234   case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
10235     return ShortFractTy;
10236   case BuiltinType::UFract:
10237     return FractTy;
10238   case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
10239     return LongFractTy;
10240   case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
10241     return SatShortFractTy;
10242   case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
10243     return SatFractTy;
10244   case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
10245     return SatLongFractTy;
10246   default:
10247     llvm_unreachable("Unexpected unsigned integer or fixed point type");
10248   }
10249 }
10250 
10251 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() = default;
10252 
10253 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
10254                                             QualType ReturnType) {}
10255 
10256 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10257 //                          Builtin Type Computation
10258 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10259 
10260 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
10261 /// pointer over the consumed characters.  This returns the resultant type.  If
10262 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
10263 /// types.  This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
10264 /// a vector of "i*".
10265 ///
10266 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
10267 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
10268 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
10269                                   ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
10270                                   bool &RequiresICE,
10271                                   bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
10272   // Modifiers.
10273   int HowLong = 0;
10274   bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
10275   RequiresICE = false;
10276 
10277   // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
10278   bool Done = false;
10279   #ifndef NDEBUG
10280   bool IsSpecial = false;
10281   #endif
10282   while (!Done) {
10283     switch (*Str++) {
10284     default: Done = true; --Str; break;
10285     case 'I':
10286       RequiresICE = true;
10287       break;
10288     case 'S':
10289       assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
10290       assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
10291       Signed = true;
10292       break;
10293     case 'U':
10294       assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
10295       assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
10296       Unsigned = true;
10297       break;
10298     case 'L':
10299       assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use 'L' with 'W', 'N', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers");
10300       assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
10301       ++HowLong;
10302       break;
10303     case 'N':
10304       // 'N' behaves like 'L' for all non LP64 targets and 'int' otherwise.
10305       assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
10306       assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'N' modifiers!");
10307       #ifndef NDEBUG
10308       IsSpecial = true;
10309       #endif
10310       if (Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32)
10311         ++HowLong;
10312       break;
10313     case 'W':
10314       // This modifier represents int64 type.
10315       assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
10316       assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
10317       #ifndef NDEBUG
10318       IsSpecial = true;
10319       #endif
10320       switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
10321       default:
10322         llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
10323       case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
10324         HowLong = 1;
10325         break;
10326       case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
10327         HowLong = 2;
10328         break;
10329       }
10330       break;
10331     case 'Z':
10332       // This modifier represents int32 type.
10333       assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
10334       assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'Z' modifiers!");
10335       #ifndef NDEBUG
10336       IsSpecial = true;
10337       #endif
10338       switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(32, true)) {
10339       default:
10340         llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
10341       case TargetInfo::SignedInt:
10342         HowLong = 0;
10343         break;
10344       case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
10345         HowLong = 1;
10346         break;
10347       case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
10348         HowLong = 2;
10349         break;
10350       }
10351       break;
10352     case 'O':
10353       assert(!IsSpecial && "Can't use two 'N', 'W', 'Z' or 'O' modifiers!");
10354       assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'O' modifiers!");
10355       #ifndef NDEBUG
10356       IsSpecial = true;
10357       #endif
10358       if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
10359         HowLong = 1;
10360       else
10361         HowLong = 2;
10362       break;
10363     }
10364   }
10365 
10366   QualType Type;
10367 
10368   // Read the base type.
10369   switch (*Str++) {
10370   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
10371   case 'y':
10372     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
10373            "Bad modifiers used with 'y'!");
10374     Type = Context.BFloat16Ty;
10375     break;
10376   case 'v':
10377     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
10378            "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
10379     Type = Context.VoidTy;
10380     break;
10381   case 'h':
10382     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
10383            "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
10384     Type = Context.HalfTy;
10385     break;
10386   case 'f':
10387     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
10388            "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
10389     Type = Context.FloatTy;
10390     break;
10391   case 'd':
10392     assert(HowLong < 3 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
10393            "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
10394     if (HowLong == 1)
10395       Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
10396     else if (HowLong == 2)
10397       Type = Context.Float128Ty;
10398     else
10399       Type = Context.DoubleTy;
10400     break;
10401   case 's':
10402     assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
10403     if (Unsigned)
10404       Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
10405     else
10406       Type = Context.ShortTy;
10407     break;
10408   case 'i':
10409     if (HowLong == 3)
10410       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
10411     else if (HowLong == 2)
10412       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
10413     else if (HowLong == 1)
10414       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
10415     else
10416       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
10417     break;
10418   case 'c':
10419     assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
10420     if (Signed)
10421       Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
10422     else if (Unsigned)
10423       Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
10424     else
10425       Type = Context.CharTy;
10426     break;
10427   case 'b': // boolean
10428     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
10429     Type = Context.BoolTy;
10430     break;
10431   case 'z':  // size_t.
10432     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
10433     Type = Context.getSizeType();
10434     break;
10435   case 'w':  // wchar_t.
10436     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!");
10437     Type = Context.getWideCharType();
10438     break;
10439   case 'F':
10440     Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
10441     break;
10442   case 'G':
10443     Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
10444     break;
10445   case 'H':
10446     Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
10447     break;
10448   case 'M':
10449     Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
10450     break;
10451   case 'a':
10452     Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
10453     assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
10454     break;
10455   case 'A':
10456     // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
10457     // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
10458     // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
10459     // passed by reference.  An example of a by-value va_list is
10460     // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
10461     // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
10462     // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
10463     // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
10464     Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
10465     assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
10466     if (Type->isArrayType())
10467       Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
10468     else
10469       Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
10470     break;
10471   case 'q': {
10472     char *End;
10473     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
10474     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
10475     Str = End;
10476 
10477     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
10478                                              RequiresICE, false);
10479     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
10480 
10481     Type = Context.getScalableVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
10482     break;
10483   }
10484   case 'V': {
10485     char *End;
10486     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
10487     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
10488     Str = End;
10489 
10490     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
10491                                              RequiresICE, false);
10492     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
10493 
10494     // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
10495     Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
10496                                  VectorType::GenericVector);
10497     break;
10498   }
10499   case 'E': {
10500     char *End;
10501 
10502     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
10503     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
10504 
10505     Str = End;
10506 
10507     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
10508                                              false);
10509     Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
10510     break;
10511   }
10512   case 'X': {
10513     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
10514                                              false);
10515     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
10516     Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
10517     break;
10518   }
10519   case 'Y':
10520     Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
10521     break;
10522   case 'P':
10523     Type = Context.getFILEType();
10524     if (Type.isNull()) {
10525       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
10526       return {};
10527     }
10528     break;
10529   case 'J':
10530     if (Signed)
10531       Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
10532     else
10533       Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
10534 
10535     if (Type.isNull()) {
10536       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
10537       return {};
10538     }
10539     break;
10540   case 'K':
10541     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
10542     Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
10543 
10544     if (Type.isNull()) {
10545       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
10546       return {};
10547     }
10548     break;
10549   case 'p':
10550     Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
10551     break;
10552   }
10553 
10554   // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
10555   Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
10556   while (!Done) {
10557     switch (char c = *Str++) {
10558     default: Done = true; --Str; break;
10559     case '*':
10560     case '&': {
10561       // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
10562       // qualified with an address space.
10563       char *End;
10564       unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
10565       if (End != Str) {
10566         // Note AddrSpace == 0 is not the same as an unspecified address space.
10567         Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(
10568           Type,
10569           Context.getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(AddrSpace));
10570         Str = End;
10571       }
10572       if (c == '*')
10573         Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
10574       else
10575         Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
10576       break;
10577     }
10578     // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
10579     case 'C':
10580       Type = Type.withConst();
10581       break;
10582     case 'D':
10583       Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
10584       break;
10585     case 'R':
10586       Type = Type.withRestrict();
10587       break;
10588     }
10589   }
10590 
10591   assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
10592          "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
10593 
10594   return Type;
10595 }
10596 
10597 // On some targets such as PowerPC, some of the builtins are defined with custom
10598 // type decriptors for target-dependent types. These descriptors are decoded in
10599 // other functions, but it may be useful to be able to fall back to default
10600 // descriptor decoding to define builtins mixing target-dependent and target-
10601 // independent types. This function allows decoding one type descriptor with
10602 // default decoding.
10603 QualType ASTContext::DecodeTypeStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
10604                                    GetBuiltinTypeError &Error, bool &RequireICE,
10605                                    bool AllowTypeModifiers) const {
10606   return DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequireICE, AllowTypeModifiers);
10607 }
10608 
10609 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
10610 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
10611                                     GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
10612                                     unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
10613   const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
10614   if (TypeStr[0] == '\0') {
10615     Error = GE_Missing_type;
10616     return {};
10617   }
10618 
10619   SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
10620 
10621   bool RequiresICE = false;
10622   Error = GE_None;
10623   QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
10624                                        RequiresICE, true);
10625   if (Error != GE_None)
10626     return {};
10627 
10628   assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
10629 
10630   while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
10631     QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
10632     if (Error != GE_None)
10633       return {};
10634 
10635     // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
10636     // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
10637     if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
10638       *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
10639 
10640     // Do array -> pointer decay.  The builtin should use the decayed type.
10641     if (Ty->isArrayType())
10642       Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
10643 
10644     ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
10645   }
10646 
10647   if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
10648     return {};
10649 
10650   assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
10651          "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
10652 
10653   bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
10654 
10655   FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(getDefaultCallingConvention(
10656       Variadic, /*IsCXXMethod=*/false, /*IsBuiltin=*/true));
10657   if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
10658 
10659 
10660   // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here.
10661   if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
10662     return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
10663 
10664   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
10665   EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
10666   EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
10667   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
10668     EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
10669         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
10670 
10671   return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
10672 }
10673 
10674 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
10675                                              const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10676   if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
10677     return GVA_Internal;
10678 
10679   // Non-user-provided functions get emitted as weak definitions with every
10680   // use, no matter whether they've been explicitly instantiated etc.
10681   if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
10682     if (!MD->isUserProvided())
10683       return GVA_DiscardableODR;
10684 
10685   GVALinkage External;
10686   switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
10687   case TSK_Undeclared:
10688   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
10689     External = GVA_StrongExternal;
10690     break;
10691 
10692   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
10693     return GVA_StrongODR;
10694 
10695   // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
10696   //   [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
10697   //   an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
10698   //   instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
10699   //   inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
10700   //   generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
10701   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
10702     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
10703 
10704   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
10705     External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
10706     break;
10707   }
10708 
10709   if (!FD->isInlined())
10710     return External;
10711 
10712   if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
10713        !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
10714        !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
10715       FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
10716     // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
10717 
10718     // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
10719     // externally visible.
10720     if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
10721       return External;
10722 
10723     // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
10724     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
10725   }
10726 
10727   // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
10728   // forcibly get emitted.  While the body of the function cannot be later
10729   // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
10730   if (FD->isMSExternInline())
10731     return GVA_StrongODR;
10732 
10733   return GVA_DiscardableODR;
10734 }
10735 
10736 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
10737                                                 const Decl *D, GVALinkage L) {
10738   // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
10739   // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
10740   if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
10741     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
10742       return GVA_AvailableExternally;
10743   } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
10744     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
10745       return GVA_StrongODR;
10746   } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) {
10747     // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
10748     // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
10749     if (D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>() &&
10750         (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal))
10751       return GVA_StrongODR;
10752     // Single source offloading languages like CUDA/HIP need to be able to
10753     // access static device variables from host code of the same compilation
10754     // unit. This is done by externalizing the static variable with a shared
10755     // name between the host and device compilation which is the same for the
10756     // same compilation unit whereas different among different compilation
10757     // units.
10758     if (Context.shouldExternalizeStaticVar(D))
10759       return GVA_StrongExternal;
10760   }
10761   return L;
10762 }
10763 
10764 /// Adjust the GVALinkage for a declaration based on what an external AST source
10765 /// knows about whether there can be other definitions of this declaration.
10766 static GVALinkage
10767 adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext &Ctx, const Decl *D,
10768                                           GVALinkage L) {
10769   ExternalASTSource *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
10770   if (!Source)
10771     return L;
10772 
10773   switch (Source->hasExternalDefinitions(D)) {
10774   case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never:
10775     // Other translation units rely on us to provide the definition.
10776     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
10777       return GVA_StrongODR;
10778     break;
10779 
10780   case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always:
10781     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
10782 
10783   case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy:
10784     break;
10785   }
10786   return L;
10787 }
10788 
10789 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
10790   return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, FD,
10791            adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, FD,
10792              basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD)));
10793 }
10794 
10795 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
10796                                              const VarDecl *VD) {
10797   if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
10798     return GVA_Internal;
10799 
10800   if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
10801     const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
10802     while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
10803       LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
10804 
10805     // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl
10806     // LexicalContext.
10807     if (!LexicalContext)
10808       return GVA_DiscardableODR;
10809 
10810     // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the
10811     // nearest enclosing function.
10812     auto StaticLocalLinkage =
10813         Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
10814 
10815     // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must
10816     // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it
10817     // contains, whether inline or out-of-line."
10818     // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use
10819     // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are
10820     // known/supported currently.
10821     if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ||
10822         StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
10823       return GVA_DiscardableODR;
10824     return StaticLocalLinkage;
10825   }
10826 
10827   // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
10828   // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
10829   // cause link errors.
10830   if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
10831     return GVA_DiscardableODR;
10832 
10833   // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
10834   // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
10835   GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
10836   switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
10837   case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
10838     StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
10839     break;
10840   case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
10841   case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
10842     StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
10843     break;
10844   case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
10845     StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
10846     break;
10847   }
10848 
10849   switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
10850   case TSK_Undeclared:
10851     return StrongLinkage;
10852 
10853   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
10854     return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
10855                    VD->isStaticDataMember()
10856                ? GVA_StrongODR
10857                : StrongLinkage;
10858 
10859   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
10860     return GVA_StrongODR;
10861 
10862   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
10863     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
10864 
10865   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
10866     return GVA_DiscardableODR;
10867   }
10868 
10869   llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
10870 }
10871 
10872 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
10873   return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, VD,
10874            adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, VD,
10875              basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD)));
10876 }
10877 
10878 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
10879   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
10880     if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
10881       return false;
10882     // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
10883     if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
10884       return false;
10885     if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
10886         isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
10887       return false;
10888   } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
10889     // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
10890     if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
10891       return false;
10892   } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
10893     return true;
10894   else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
10895     return true;
10896   else if (isa<OMPRequiresDecl>(D))
10897     return true;
10898   else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
10899     return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
10900   else if (isa<OMPAllocateDecl>(D))
10901     return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
10902   else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(D))
10903     return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
10904   else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
10905     return true;
10906   else
10907     return false;
10908 
10909   // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
10910   if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10911     return false;
10912 
10913   // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
10914   if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
10915     return false;
10916 
10917   // Aliases and used decls are required.
10918   if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
10919     return true;
10920 
10921   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
10922     // Forward declarations aren't required.
10923     if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
10924       return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
10925 
10926     // Constructors and destructors are required.
10927     if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
10928       return true;
10929 
10930     // The key function for a class is required.  This rule only comes
10931     // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
10932     if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
10933       if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
10934         const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
10935         if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
10936           const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
10937           if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
10938             return true;
10939         }
10940       }
10941     }
10942 
10943     GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
10944 
10945     // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
10946     // always be deferred.  Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
10947     // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
10948     return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage);
10949   }
10950 
10951   const auto *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
10952   assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
10953 
10954   // If the decl is marked as `declare target to`, it should be emitted for the
10955   // host and for the device.
10956   if (LangOpts.OpenMP &&
10957       OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(VD))
10958     return true;
10959 
10960   if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
10961       !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
10962     return false;
10963 
10964   // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
10965   auto Linkage = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
10966   if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage))
10967     return true;
10968 
10969   // We never need to emit a variable that is available in another TU.
10970   if (Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
10971     return false;
10972 
10973   // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
10974   if (VD->needsDestruction(*this))
10975     return true;
10976 
10977   // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
10978   if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
10979       // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery.
10980       (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
10981     return true;
10982 
10983   // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
10984   // bindings have side-effects.
10985   if (const auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
10986     for (const auto *BD : DD->bindings())
10987       if (const auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
10988         if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
10989           return true;
10990 
10991   return false;
10992 }
10993 
10994 void ASTContext::forEachMultiversionedFunctionVersion(
10995     const FunctionDecl *FD,
10996     llvm::function_ref<void(FunctionDecl *)> Pred) const {
10997   assert(FD->isMultiVersion() && "Only valid for multiversioned functions");
10998   llvm::SmallDenseSet<const FunctionDecl*, 4> SeenDecls;
10999   FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
11000   // FIXME: The order of traversal here matters and depends on the order of
11001   // lookup results, which happens to be (mostly) oldest-to-newest, but we
11002   // shouldn't rely on that.
11003   for (auto *CurDecl :
11004        FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->lookup(FD->getDeclName())) {
11005     FunctionDecl *CurFD = CurDecl->getAsFunction()->getMostRecentDecl();
11006     if (CurFD && hasSameType(CurFD->getType(), FD->getType()) &&
11007         std::end(SeenDecls) == llvm::find(SeenDecls, CurFD)) {
11008       SeenDecls.insert(CurFD);
11009       Pred(CurFD);
11010     }
11011   }
11012 }
11013 
11014 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
11015                                                     bool IsCXXMethod,
11016                                                     bool IsBuiltin) const {
11017   // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
11018   if (IsCXXMethod)
11019     return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
11020 
11021   // Builtins ignore user-specified default calling convention and remain the
11022   // Target's default calling convention.
11023   if (!IsBuiltin) {
11024     switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
11025     case LangOptions::DCC_None:
11026       break;
11027     case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
11028       return CC_C;
11029     case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
11030       if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2") && !IsVariadic)
11031         return CC_X86FastCall;
11032       break;
11033     case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
11034       if (!IsVariadic)
11035         return CC_X86StdCall;
11036       break;
11037     case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
11038       // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
11039       if (!IsVariadic)
11040         return CC_X86VectorCall;
11041       break;
11042     case LangOptions::DCC_RegCall:
11043       // __regcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
11044       if (!IsVariadic)
11045         return CC_X86RegCall;
11046       break;
11047     }
11048   }
11049   return Target->getDefaultCallingConv();
11050 }
11051 
11052 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
11053   // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
11054   return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
11055 }
11056 
11057 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
11058   if (!VTContext.get()) {
11059     auto ABI = Target->getCXXABI();
11060     if (ABI.isMicrosoft())
11061       VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
11062     else {
11063       auto ComponentLayout = getLangOpts().RelativeCXXABIVTables
11064                                  ? ItaniumVTableContext::Relative
11065                                  : ItaniumVTableContext::Pointer;
11066       VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this, ComponentLayout));
11067     }
11068   }
11069   return VTContext.get();
11070 }
11071 
11072 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext(const TargetInfo *T) {
11073   if (!T)
11074     T = Target;
11075   switch (T->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
11076   case TargetCXXABI::AppleARM64:
11077   case TargetCXXABI::Fuchsia:
11078   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
11079   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
11080   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
11081   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
11082   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
11083   case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
11084   case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
11085   case TargetCXXABI::XL:
11086     return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
11087   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
11088     return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
11089   }
11090   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
11091 }
11092 
11093 MangleContext *ASTContext::createDeviceMangleContext(const TargetInfo &T) {
11094   assert(T.getCXXABI().getKind() != TargetCXXABI::Microsoft &&
11095          "Device mangle context does not support Microsoft mangling.");
11096   switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
11097   case TargetCXXABI::AppleARM64:
11098   case TargetCXXABI::Fuchsia:
11099   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
11100   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
11101   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
11102   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
11103   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
11104   case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
11105   case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
11106   case TargetCXXABI::XL:
11107     return ItaniumMangleContext::create(
11108         *this, getDiagnostics(),
11109         [](ASTContext &, const NamedDecl *ND) -> llvm::Optional<unsigned> {
11110           if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND))
11111             return RD->getDeviceLambdaManglingNumber();
11112           return llvm::None;
11113         });
11114   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
11115     return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
11116   }
11117   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
11118 }
11119 
11120 CXXABI::~CXXABI() = default;
11121 
11122 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
11123   return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
11124          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
11125          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
11126          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
11127          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
11128          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
11129          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
11130          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
11131          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
11132          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
11133          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
11134          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
11135          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes);
11136 }
11137 
11138 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
11139 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
11140 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
11141 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
11142 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
11143                                            unsigned Signed) const {
11144   TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
11145   CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
11146   if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
11147     return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
11148   return QualTy;
11149 }
11150 
11151 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
11152 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
11153 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
11154 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
11155                                             bool ExplicitIEEE) const {
11156   TargetInfo::RealType Ty =
11157       getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth, ExplicitIEEE);
11158   switch (Ty) {
11159   case TargetInfo::Float:
11160     return FloatTy;
11161   case TargetInfo::Double:
11162     return DoubleTy;
11163   case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
11164     return LongDoubleTy;
11165   case TargetInfo::Float128:
11166     return Float128Ty;
11167   case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
11168     return {};
11169   }
11170 
11171   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
11172 }
11173 
11174 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
11175   if (Number > 1)
11176     MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
11177 }
11178 
11179 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
11180   auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
11181   return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
11182 }
11183 
11184 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
11185   if (Number > 1)
11186     StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
11187 }
11188 
11189 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
11190   auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
11191   return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
11192 }
11193 
11194 MangleNumberingContext &
11195 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
11196   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus);  // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
11197   std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
11198   if (!MCtx)
11199     MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
11200   return *MCtx;
11201 }
11202 
11203 MangleNumberingContext &
11204 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(NeedExtraManglingDecl_t, const Decl *D) {
11205   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
11206   std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx =
11207       ExtraMangleNumberingContexts[D];
11208   if (!MCtx)
11209     MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
11210   return *MCtx;
11211 }
11212 
11213 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
11214 ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
11215   return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
11216 }
11217 
11218 const CXXConstructorDecl *
11219 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
11220   return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
11221       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
11222 }
11223 
11224 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
11225                                                       CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
11226   return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
11227       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
11228       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
11229 }
11230 
11231 void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
11232                                                  TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
11233   return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
11234 }
11235 
11236 TypedefNameDecl *
11237 ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
11238   return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
11239 }
11240 
11241 void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
11242                                                 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
11243   return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
11244 }
11245 
11246 DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
11247   return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
11248 }
11249 
11250 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
11251   ParamIndices[D] = index;
11252 }
11253 
11254 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
11255   ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
11256   assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
11257          "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
11258   return I->second;
11259 }
11260 
11261 QualType ASTContext::getStringLiteralArrayType(QualType EltTy,
11262                                                unsigned Length) const {
11263   // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
11264   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings)
11265     EltTy = EltTy.withConst();
11266 
11267   EltTy = adjustStringLiteralBaseType(EltTy);
11268 
11269   // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
11270   // the null terminator character.
11271   return getConstantArrayType(EltTy, llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), nullptr,
11272                               ArrayType::Normal, /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
11273 }
11274 
11275 StringLiteral *
11276 ASTContext::getPredefinedStringLiteralFromCache(StringRef Key) const {
11277   StringLiteral *&Result = StringLiteralCache[Key];
11278   if (!Result)
11279     Result = StringLiteral::Create(
11280         *this, Key, StringLiteral::Ascii,
11281         /*Pascal*/ false, getStringLiteralArrayType(CharTy, Key.size()),
11282         SourceLocation());
11283   return Result;
11284 }
11285 
11286 MSGuidDecl *
11287 ASTContext::getMSGuidDecl(MSGuidDecl::Parts Parts) const {
11288   assert(MSGuidTagDecl && "building MS GUID without MS extensions?");
11289 
11290   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
11291   MSGuidDecl::Profile(ID, Parts);
11292 
11293   void *InsertPos;
11294   if (MSGuidDecl *Existing = MSGuidDecls.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
11295     return Existing;
11296 
11297   QualType GUIDType = getMSGuidType().withConst();
11298   MSGuidDecl *New = MSGuidDecl::Create(*this, GUIDType, Parts);
11299   MSGuidDecls.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
11300   return New;
11301 }
11302 
11303 TemplateParamObjectDecl *
11304 ASTContext::getTemplateParamObjectDecl(QualType T, const APValue &V) const {
11305   assert(T->isRecordType() && "template param object of unexpected type");
11306 
11307   // C++ [temp.param]p8:
11308   //   [...] a static storage duration object of type 'const T' [...]
11309   T.addConst();
11310 
11311   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
11312   TemplateParamObjectDecl::Profile(ID, T, V);
11313 
11314   void *InsertPos;
11315   if (TemplateParamObjectDecl *Existing =
11316           TemplateParamObjectDecls.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
11317     return Existing;
11318 
11319   TemplateParamObjectDecl *New = TemplateParamObjectDecl::Create(*this, T, V);
11320   TemplateParamObjectDecls.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
11321   return New;
11322 }
11323 
11324 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
11325   const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
11326   if (!T.isOSDarwin())
11327     return false;
11328 
11329   if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
11330       !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
11331     return false;
11332 
11333   QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
11334   CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
11335   uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
11336   CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
11337   unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
11338   unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
11339   return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
11340 }
11341 
11342 bool
11343 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
11344                                 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
11345   // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
11346   if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
11347       || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
11348     return false;
11349   if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
11350       MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
11351     return false;
11352   if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
11353     return false;
11354 
11355   if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
11356     return false;
11357 
11358   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
11359        IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
11360        EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
11361        IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
11362     const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
11363     const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
11364     if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
11365       return false;
11366     if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
11367       return false;
11368   }
11369 
11370   return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
11371 }
11372 
11373 uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const {
11374   LangAS AS;
11375   if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType())
11376     AS = LangAS::Default;
11377   else
11378     AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
11379 
11380   return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS);
11381 }
11382 
11383 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const {
11384   if (isTargetAddressSpace(AS))
11385     return toTargetAddressSpace(AS);
11386   else
11387     return (*AddrSpaceMap)[(unsigned)AS];
11388 }
11389 
11390 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSaturatedType(QualType Ty) const {
11391   assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
11392 
11393   if (Ty->isSaturatedFixedPointType()) return Ty;
11394 
11395   switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
11396     default:
11397       llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!");
11398     case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
11399       return SatShortAccumTy;
11400     case BuiltinType::Accum:
11401       return SatAccumTy;
11402     case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
11403       return SatLongAccumTy;
11404     case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
11405       return SatUnsignedShortAccumTy;
11406     case BuiltinType::UAccum:
11407       return SatUnsignedAccumTy;
11408     case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
11409       return SatUnsignedLongAccumTy;
11410     case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
11411       return SatShortFractTy;
11412     case BuiltinType::Fract:
11413       return SatFractTy;
11414     case BuiltinType::LongFract:
11415       return SatLongFractTy;
11416     case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
11417       return SatUnsignedShortFractTy;
11418     case BuiltinType::UFract:
11419       return SatUnsignedFractTy;
11420     case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
11421       return SatUnsignedLongFractTy;
11422   }
11423 }
11424 
11425 LangAS ASTContext::getLangASForBuiltinAddressSpace(unsigned AS) const {
11426   if (LangOpts.OpenCL)
11427     return getTargetInfo().getOpenCLBuiltinAddressSpace(AS);
11428 
11429   if (LangOpts.CUDA)
11430     return getTargetInfo().getCUDABuiltinAddressSpace(AS);
11431 
11432   return getLangASFromTargetAS(AS);
11433 }
11434 
11435 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
11436 // doesn't include ASTContext.h
11437 template
11438 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
11439     const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
11440 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
11441     const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
11442         const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);
11443 
11444 unsigned char ASTContext::getFixedPointScale(QualType Ty) const {
11445   assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
11446 
11447   const TargetInfo &Target = getTargetInfo();
11448   switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
11449     default:
11450       llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!");
11451     case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
11452     case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
11453       return Target.getShortAccumScale();
11454     case BuiltinType::Accum:
11455     case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
11456       return Target.getAccumScale();
11457     case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
11458     case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
11459       return Target.getLongAccumScale();
11460     case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
11461     case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
11462       return Target.getUnsignedShortAccumScale();
11463     case BuiltinType::UAccum:
11464     case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
11465       return Target.getUnsignedAccumScale();
11466     case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
11467     case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
11468       return Target.getUnsignedLongAccumScale();
11469     case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
11470     case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
11471       return Target.getShortFractScale();
11472     case BuiltinType::Fract:
11473     case BuiltinType::SatFract:
11474       return Target.getFractScale();
11475     case BuiltinType::LongFract:
11476     case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
11477       return Target.getLongFractScale();
11478     case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
11479     case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
11480       return Target.getUnsignedShortFractScale();
11481     case BuiltinType::UFract:
11482     case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
11483       return Target.getUnsignedFractScale();
11484     case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
11485     case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
11486       return Target.getUnsignedLongFractScale();
11487   }
11488 }
11489 
11490 unsigned char ASTContext::getFixedPointIBits(QualType Ty) const {
11491   assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
11492 
11493   const TargetInfo &Target = getTargetInfo();
11494   switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
11495     default:
11496       llvm_unreachable("Not a fixed point type!");
11497     case BuiltinType::ShortAccum:
11498     case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum:
11499       return Target.getShortAccumIBits();
11500     case BuiltinType::Accum:
11501     case BuiltinType::SatAccum:
11502       return Target.getAccumIBits();
11503     case BuiltinType::LongAccum:
11504     case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum:
11505       return Target.getLongAccumIBits();
11506     case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
11507     case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
11508       return Target.getUnsignedShortAccumIBits();
11509     case BuiltinType::UAccum:
11510     case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
11511       return Target.getUnsignedAccumIBits();
11512     case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
11513     case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
11514       return Target.getUnsignedLongAccumIBits();
11515     case BuiltinType::ShortFract:
11516     case BuiltinType::SatShortFract:
11517     case BuiltinType::Fract:
11518     case BuiltinType::SatFract:
11519     case BuiltinType::LongFract:
11520     case BuiltinType::SatLongFract:
11521     case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
11522     case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
11523     case BuiltinType::UFract:
11524     case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
11525     case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
11526     case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
11527       return 0;
11528   }
11529 }
11530 
11531 llvm::FixedPointSemantics
11532 ASTContext::getFixedPointSemantics(QualType Ty) const {
11533   assert((Ty->isFixedPointType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) &&
11534          "Can only get the fixed point semantics for a "
11535          "fixed point or integer type.");
11536   if (Ty->isIntegerType())
11537     return llvm::FixedPointSemantics::GetIntegerSemantics(
11538         getIntWidth(Ty), Ty->isSignedIntegerType());
11539 
11540   bool isSigned = Ty->isSignedFixedPointType();
11541   return llvm::FixedPointSemantics(
11542       static_cast<unsigned>(getTypeSize(Ty)), getFixedPointScale(Ty), isSigned,
11543       Ty->isSaturatedFixedPointType(),
11544       !isSigned && getTargetInfo().doUnsignedFixedPointTypesHavePadding());
11545 }
11546 
11547 llvm::APFixedPoint ASTContext::getFixedPointMax(QualType Ty) const {
11548   assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
11549   return llvm::APFixedPoint::getMax(getFixedPointSemantics(Ty));
11550 }
11551 
11552 llvm::APFixedPoint ASTContext::getFixedPointMin(QualType Ty) const {
11553   assert(Ty->isFixedPointType());
11554   return llvm::APFixedPoint::getMin(getFixedPointSemantics(Ty));
11555 }
11556 
11557 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(QualType Ty) const {
11558   assert(Ty->isUnsignedFixedPointType() &&
11559          "Expected unsigned fixed point type");
11560 
11561   switch (Ty->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
11562   case BuiltinType::UShortAccum:
11563     return ShortAccumTy;
11564   case BuiltinType::UAccum:
11565     return AccumTy;
11566   case BuiltinType::ULongAccum:
11567     return LongAccumTy;
11568   case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum:
11569     return SatShortAccumTy;
11570   case BuiltinType::SatUAccum:
11571     return SatAccumTy;
11572   case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum:
11573     return SatLongAccumTy;
11574   case BuiltinType::UShortFract:
11575     return ShortFractTy;
11576   case BuiltinType::UFract:
11577     return FractTy;
11578   case BuiltinType::ULongFract:
11579     return LongFractTy;
11580   case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract:
11581     return SatShortFractTy;
11582   case BuiltinType::SatUFract:
11583     return SatFractTy;
11584   case BuiltinType::SatULongFract:
11585     return SatLongFractTy;
11586   default:
11587     llvm_unreachable("Unexpected unsigned fixed point type");
11588   }
11589 }
11590 
11591 ParsedTargetAttr
11592 ASTContext::filterFunctionTargetAttrs(const TargetAttr *TD) const {
11593   assert(TD != nullptr);
11594   ParsedTargetAttr ParsedAttr = TD->parse();
11595 
11596   ParsedAttr.Features.erase(
11597       llvm::remove_if(ParsedAttr.Features,
11598                       [&](const std::string &Feat) {
11599                         return !Target->isValidFeatureName(
11600                             StringRef{Feat}.substr(1));
11601                       }),
11602       ParsedAttr.Features.end());
11603   return ParsedAttr;
11604 }
11605 
11606 void ASTContext::getFunctionFeatureMap(llvm::StringMap<bool> &FeatureMap,
11607                                        const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
11608   if (FD)
11609     getFunctionFeatureMap(FeatureMap, GlobalDecl().getWithDecl(FD));
11610   else
11611     Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(),
11612                            Target->getTargetOpts().CPU,
11613                            Target->getTargetOpts().Features);
11614 }
11615 
11616 // Fills in the supplied string map with the set of target features for the
11617 // passed in function.
11618 void ASTContext::getFunctionFeatureMap(llvm::StringMap<bool> &FeatureMap,
11619                                        GlobalDecl GD) const {
11620   StringRef TargetCPU = Target->getTargetOpts().CPU;
11621   const FunctionDecl *FD = GD.getDecl()->getAsFunction();
11622   if (const auto *TD = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>()) {
11623     ParsedTargetAttr ParsedAttr = filterFunctionTargetAttrs(TD);
11624 
11625     // Make a copy of the features as passed on the command line into the
11626     // beginning of the additional features from the function to override.
11627     ParsedAttr.Features.insert(
11628         ParsedAttr.Features.begin(),
11629         Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.begin(),
11630         Target->getTargetOpts().FeaturesAsWritten.end());
11631 
11632     if (ParsedAttr.Architecture != "" &&
11633         Target->isValidCPUName(ParsedAttr.Architecture))
11634       TargetCPU = ParsedAttr.Architecture;
11635 
11636     // Now populate the feature map, first with the TargetCPU which is either
11637     // the default or a new one from the target attribute string. Then we'll use
11638     // the passed in features (FeaturesAsWritten) along with the new ones from
11639     // the attribute.
11640     Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU,
11641                            ParsedAttr.Features);
11642   } else if (const auto *SD = FD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>()) {
11643     llvm::SmallVector<StringRef, 32> FeaturesTmp;
11644     Target->getCPUSpecificCPUDispatchFeatures(
11645         SD->getCPUName(GD.getMultiVersionIndex())->getName(), FeaturesTmp);
11646     std::vector<std::string> Features(FeaturesTmp.begin(), FeaturesTmp.end());
11647     Target->initFeatureMap(FeatureMap, getDiagnostics(), TargetCPU, Features);
11648   } else {
11649     FeatureMap = Target->getTargetOpts().FeatureMap;
11650   }
11651 }
11652 
11653 OMPTraitInfo &ASTContext::getNewOMPTraitInfo() {
11654   OMPTraitInfoVector.emplace_back(new OMPTraitInfo());
11655   return *OMPTraitInfoVector.back();
11656 }
11657 
11658 const StreamingDiagnostic &clang::
11659 operator<<(const StreamingDiagnostic &DB,
11660            const ASTContext::SectionInfo &Section) {
11661   if (Section.Decl)
11662     return DB << Section.Decl;
11663   return DB << "a prior #pragma section";
11664 }
11665 
11666 bool ASTContext::mayExternalizeStaticVar(const Decl *D) const {
11667   bool IsStaticVar =
11668       isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->getStorageClass() == SC_Static;
11669   bool IsExplicitDeviceVar = (D->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() &&
11670                               !D->getAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>()->isImplicit()) ||
11671                              (D->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>() &&
11672                               !D->getAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>()->isImplicit());
11673   // CUDA/HIP: static managed variables need to be externalized since it is
11674   // a declaration in IR, therefore cannot have internal linkage.
11675   return IsStaticVar &&
11676          (D->hasAttr<HIPManagedAttr>() || IsExplicitDeviceVar);
11677 }
11678 
11679 bool ASTContext::shouldExternalizeStaticVar(const Decl *D) const {
11680   return mayExternalizeStaticVar(D) &&
11681          (D->hasAttr<HIPManagedAttr>() ||
11682           CUDADeviceVarODRUsedByHost.count(cast<VarDecl>(D)));
11683 }
11684 
11685 StringRef ASTContext::getCUIDHash() const {
11686   if (!CUIDHash.empty())
11687     return CUIDHash;
11688   if (LangOpts.CUID.empty())
11689     return StringRef();
11690   CUIDHash = llvm::utohexstr(llvm::MD5Hash(LangOpts.CUID), /*LowerCase=*/true);
11691   return CUIDHash;
11692 }
11693 
11694 // Get the closest named parent, so we can order the sycl naming decls somewhere
11695 // that mangling is meaningful.
11696 static const DeclContext *GetNamedParent(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
11697   const DeclContext *DC = RD->getDeclContext();
11698 
11699   while (!isa<NamedDecl, TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
11700     DC = DC->getParent();
11701   return DC;
11702 }
11703 
11704 void ASTContext::AddSYCLKernelNamingDecl(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
11705   assert(getLangOpts().isSYCL() && "Only valid for SYCL programs");
11706   RD = RD->getCanonicalDecl();
11707   const DeclContext *DC = GetNamedParent(RD);
11708 
11709   assert(RD->getLocation().isValid() &&
11710          "Invalid location on kernel naming decl");
11711 
11712   (void)SYCLKernelNamingTypes[DC].insert(RD);
11713 }
11714 
11715 bool ASTContext::IsSYCLKernelNamingDecl(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
11716   assert(getLangOpts().isSYCL() && "Only valid for SYCL programs");
11717   const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND);
11718   if (!RD)
11719     return false;
11720   RD = RD->getCanonicalDecl();
11721   const DeclContext *DC = GetNamedParent(RD);
11722 
11723   auto Itr = SYCLKernelNamingTypes.find(DC);
11724 
11725   if (Itr == SYCLKernelNamingTypes.end())
11726     return false;
11727 
11728   return Itr->getSecond().count(RD);
11729 }
11730 
11731 // Filters the Decls list to those that share the lambda mangling with the
11732 // passed RD.
11733 void ASTContext::FilterSYCLKernelNamingDecls(
11734     const CXXRecordDecl *RD,
11735     llvm::SmallVectorImpl<const CXXRecordDecl *> &Decls) {
11736 
11737   if (!SYCLKernelFilterContext)
11738     SYCLKernelFilterContext.reset(
11739         ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics()));
11740 
11741   llvm::SmallString<128> LambdaSig;
11742   llvm::raw_svector_ostream Out(LambdaSig);
11743   SYCLKernelFilterContext->mangleLambdaSig(RD, Out);
11744 
11745   llvm::erase_if(Decls, [this, &LambdaSig](const CXXRecordDecl *LocalRD) {
11746     llvm::SmallString<128> LocalLambdaSig;
11747     llvm::raw_svector_ostream LocalOut(LocalLambdaSig);
11748     SYCLKernelFilterContext->mangleLambdaSig(LocalRD, LocalOut);
11749     return LambdaSig != LocalLambdaSig;
11750   });
11751 }
11752 
11753 unsigned ASTContext::GetSYCLKernelNamingIndex(const NamedDecl *ND) {
11754   assert(getLangOpts().isSYCL() && "Only valid for SYCL programs");
11755   assert(IsSYCLKernelNamingDecl(ND) &&
11756          "Lambda not involved in mangling asked for a naming index?");
11757 
11758   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND)->getCanonicalDecl();
11759   const DeclContext *DC = GetNamedParent(RD);
11760 
11761   auto Itr = SYCLKernelNamingTypes.find(DC);
11762   assert(Itr != SYCLKernelNamingTypes.end() && "Not a valid DeclContext?");
11763 
11764   const llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXRecordDecl *, 4> &Set = Itr->getSecond();
11765 
11766   llvm::SmallVector<const CXXRecordDecl *> Decls{Set.begin(), Set.end()};
11767 
11768   FilterSYCLKernelNamingDecls(RD, Decls);
11769 
11770   llvm::sort(Decls, [](const CXXRecordDecl *LHS, const CXXRecordDecl *RHS) {
11771     return LHS->getLambdaManglingNumber() < RHS->getLambdaManglingNumber();
11772   });
11773 
11774   return llvm::find(Decls, RD) - Decls.begin();
11775 }
11776